Implement -var-info-path-expression.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @page
108 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
109 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
110 software in general. We will miss him.
111 @end titlepage
112 @page
113
114 @ifnottex
115 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
116
117 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
118
119 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
120
121 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
122 @value{GDBVN}.
123
124 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
125
126 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
127 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
128 software in general. We will miss him.
129
130 @menu
131 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
132 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
133
134 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
135 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
136 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
137 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
138 * Stack:: Examining the stack
139 * Source:: Examining source files
140 * Data:: Examining data
141 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
142 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
143 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
144
145 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
146
147 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
148 * Altering:: Altering execution
149 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
150 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
151 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
152 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
153 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
154 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
155 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
156 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
157 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
158 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
159 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
160
161 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
162
163 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
164 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
165 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
166 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
167 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
168 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
169 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
170 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
171 @value{GDBN}
172 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
173 how you can copy and share GDB
174 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
175 * Index:: Index
176 @end menu
177
178 @end ifnottex
179
180 @contents
181
182 @node Summary
183 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
184
185 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
186 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
187 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
188
189 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
190 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
191
192 @itemize @bullet
193 @item
194 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
195
196 @item
197 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
198
199 @item
200 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
201
202 @item
203 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
204 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
205 @end itemize
206
207 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
208 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
209 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
210
211 @cindex Modula-2
212 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
213 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
214
215 @cindex Pascal
216 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
217 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
218 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
219 syntax.
220
221 @cindex Fortran
222 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
223 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
224 underscore.
225
226 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
227 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
228
229 @menu
230 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
231 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
232 @end menu
233
234 @node Free Software
235 @unnumberedsec Free Software
236
237 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
238 General Public License
239 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
240 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
241 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
242 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
243 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
244 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
245
246 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
247 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
248 from anyone else.
249
250 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
251
252 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
253 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
254 include with the free software. Many of our most important
255 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
256 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
257 when an important free software package does not come with a free
258 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
259 gaps today.
260
261 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
262 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
263 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
264 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
265 them from the free software world.
266
267 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
268 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
269 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
270 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
271 contract to make it non-free.
272
273 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
274 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
275 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
276 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
277 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
278 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
279 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
280
281 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
282 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
283 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
284 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
285
286 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
287 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
288 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
289 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
290 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
291 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
292 community.
293
294 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
295 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
296 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
297 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
298 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
299 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
300 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
301 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
302 of the manual.
303
304 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
305 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
306 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
307 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
308 manual to replace it.
309
310 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
311 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
312 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
313 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
314 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
315 the free software community.
316
317 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
318 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
319 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
320 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
321 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
322 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
323 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
324 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
325 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
326
327 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
328 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
329 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
330 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
331 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
332 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
333 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
334 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
335
336 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
337 published by other publishers, at
338 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
339
340 @node Contributors
341 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
342
343 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
344 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
345 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
346 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
347 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
348 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
349 blow-by-blow account.
350
351 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
352
353 @quotation
354 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
355 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
356 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
357 @end quotation
358
359 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
360 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
361 releases:
362 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
363 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
364 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
365 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
366 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
367 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
368 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
369 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
370 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
371
372 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
373 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
374
375 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
376 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
377 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
378 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
379 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
380
381 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
382 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
383 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
384
385 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
386 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
387
388 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
389
390 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
391 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
392 support.
393 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
394 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
395 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
396 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
397 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
398 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
399 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
400 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
401 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
402 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
403 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
404 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
405 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
406 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
407 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
408 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
409
410 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
411
412 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
413 libraries.
414
415 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
416 about several machine instruction sets.
417
418 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
419 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
420 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
421 and RDI targets, respectively.
422
423 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
424 command-line editing and command history.
425
426 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
427 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
428
429 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
430 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
431 symbols.
432
433 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
434 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
435
436 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
437
438 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
439 processors.
440
441 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
442
443 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
444
445 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
446
447 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
448 watchpoints.
449
450 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
451
452 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
453
454 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
455 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
456
457 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
458 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
459 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
460 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
461 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
462 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
463 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
464
465 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
466 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
467
468 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
469 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
470 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
471 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
472 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
473 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
474 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
475 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
476 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
477 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
478 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
479 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
480 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
481 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
482 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
483
484 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
485 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
486
487 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
488 Hat.
489
490 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
491 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
492 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
493 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
494 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
495 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
496
497 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
498 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
499 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
500 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
501 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
502 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
503 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
504 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
505 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
506 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
507 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
508 Weigand.
509
510 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
511 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
512 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
513 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
514
515 @node Sample Session
516 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
517
518 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
519 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
520 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
521
522 @iftex
523 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
524 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
525 @end iftex
526
527 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
528 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
529
530 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
531 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
532 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
533 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
534 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
535 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
536 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
537 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
538 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
539
540 @smallexample
541 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
542 $ @b{./m4}
543 @b{define(foo,0000)}
544
545 @b{foo}
546 0000
547 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
548
549 @b{bar}
550 0000
551 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
552
553 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
554 @b{baz}
555 @b{Ctrl-d}
556 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
557 @end smallexample
558
559 @noindent
560 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
561
562 @smallexample
563 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
564 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
565 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
566 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
567 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
568 the conditions.
569 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
570 for details.
571
572 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
573 (@value{GDBP})
574 @end smallexample
575
576 @noindent
577 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
578 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
579 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
580 that examples fit in this manual.
581
582 @smallexample
583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
584 @end smallexample
585
586 @noindent
587 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
588 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
589 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
590 @code{break} command.
591
592 @smallexample
593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
594 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
595 @end smallexample
596
597 @noindent
598 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
599 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
600 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
601
602 @smallexample
603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
604 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
605 @b{define(foo,0000)}
606
607 @b{foo}
608 0000
609 @end smallexample
610
611 @noindent
612 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
613 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
614 context where it stops.
615
616 @smallexample
617 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
618
619 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
620 at builtin.c:879
621 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
622 @end smallexample
623
624 @noindent
625 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
626 the next line of the current function.
627
628 @smallexample
629 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
630 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
631 : nil,
632 @end smallexample
633
634 @noindent
635 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
636 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
637 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
638 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
639
640 @smallexample
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
642 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
643 at input.c:530
644 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
645 @end smallexample
646
647 @noindent
648 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
649 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
650 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
651 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
652 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
653 stack frame for each active subroutine.
654
655 @smallexample
656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
657 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
658 at input.c:530
659 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
660 at builtin.c:882
661 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
662 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
663 at macro.c:71
664 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
665 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
670 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
671 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
676 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
677 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
678 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
680 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
681 : xstrdup(rq);
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
688 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
689 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
690 (@code{print}) to see their values.
691
692 @smallexample
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
694 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
696 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
697 @end smallexample
698
699 @noindent
700 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
701 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
702 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
703
704 @smallexample
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
706 533 xfree(rquote);
707 534
708 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
709 : xstrdup (lq);
710 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
711 : xstrdup (rq);
712 537
713 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
714 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
715 540 @}
716 541
717 542 void
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
722 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
723
724 @smallexample
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 540 @}
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
730 $3 = 9
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
732 $4 = 7
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
737 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
738 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
739 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
740 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
741 assignments.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
745 $5 = 7
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
747 $6 = 9
748 @end smallexample
749
750 @noindent
751 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
752 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
753 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
754 example that caused trouble initially:
755
756 @smallexample
757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
758 Continuing.
759
760 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
761
762 baz
763 0000
764 @end smallexample
765
766 @noindent
767 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
768 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
769 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
770
771 @smallexample
772 @b{Ctrl-d}
773 Program exited normally.
774 @end smallexample
775
776 @noindent
777 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
778 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
779 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
780
781 @smallexample
782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
783 @end smallexample
784
785 @node Invocation
786 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
787
788 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
789 The essentials are:
790 @itemize @bullet
791 @item
792 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
793 @item
794 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
795 @end itemize
796
797 @menu
798 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
799 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
800 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
801 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
802 @end menu
803
804 @node Invoking GDB
805 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
806
807 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
808 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
809
810 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
811 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
812
813 The command-line options described here are designed
814 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
815 options may effectively be unavailable.
816
817 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
818 specifying an executable program:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
826 specified:
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
830 @end smallexample
831
832 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
833 to debug a running process:
834
835 @smallexample
836 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
837 @end smallexample
838
839 @noindent
840 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
841 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
842
843 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
844 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
845 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
846 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
847 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
848
849 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
850 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
851 option processing.
852 @smallexample
853 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
854 @end smallexample
855 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
856 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
857
858 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
859 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
860
861 @smallexample
862 @value{GDBP} -silent
863 @end smallexample
864
865 @noindent
866 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
867 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
868
869 @noindent
870 Type
871
872 @smallexample
873 @value{GDBP} -help
874 @end smallexample
875
876 @noindent
877 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
878 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
879
880 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
881 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
882 @samp{-x} option is used.
883
884
885 @menu
886 * File Options:: Choosing files
887 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
888 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
889 @end menu
890
891 @node File Options
892 @subsection Choosing Files
893
894 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
895 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
896 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
897 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
898 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
900 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
901 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
902 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
903 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
904 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
905 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
906 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
907
908 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
909 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
910 argument and ignore it.
911
912 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
913 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
914 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
915 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
916 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
917
918 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
919 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
920 @c it.
921
922 @table @code
923 @item -symbols @var{file}
924 @itemx -s @var{file}
925 @cindex @code{--symbols}
926 @cindex @code{-s}
927 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
928
929 @item -exec @var{file}
930 @itemx -e @var{file}
931 @cindex @code{--exec}
932 @cindex @code{-e}
933 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
934 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
935
936 @item -se @var{file}
937 @cindex @code{--se}
938 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
939 file.
940
941 @item -core @var{file}
942 @itemx -c @var{file}
943 @cindex @code{--core}
944 @cindex @code{-c}
945 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
946
947 @item -c @var{number}
948 @item -pid @var{number}
949 @itemx -p @var{number}
950 @cindex @code{--pid}
951 @cindex @code{-p}
952 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
953 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
954 file named @var{number}.
955
956 @item -command @var{file}
957 @itemx -x @var{file}
958 @cindex @code{--command}
959 @cindex @code{-x}
960 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
961 Files,, Command files}.
962
963 @item -eval-command @var{command}
964 @itemx -ex @var{command}
965 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
966 @cindex @code{-ex}
967 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
968
969 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
970 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
971
972 @smallexample
973 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
974 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
975 @end smallexample
976
977 @item -directory @var{directory}
978 @itemx -d @var{directory}
979 @cindex @code{--directory}
980 @cindex @code{-d}
981 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
982
983 @item -r
984 @itemx -readnow
985 @cindex @code{--readnow}
986 @cindex @code{-r}
987 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
988 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
989 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
990
991 @end table
992
993 @node Mode Options
994 @subsection Choosing Modes
995
996 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
997 batch mode or quiet mode.
998
999 @table @code
1000 @item -nx
1001 @itemx -n
1002 @cindex @code{--nx}
1003 @cindex @code{-n}
1004 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1005 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1006 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1007 Files}.
1008
1009 @item -quiet
1010 @itemx -silent
1011 @itemx -q
1012 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1013 @cindex @code{--silent}
1014 @cindex @code{-q}
1015 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1016 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1017
1018 @item -batch
1019 @cindex @code{--batch}
1020 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1021 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1022 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1023 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1024 in the command files.
1025
1026 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1027 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1028 make this more useful, the message
1029
1030 @smallexample
1031 Program exited normally.
1032 @end smallexample
1033
1034 @noindent
1035 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1036 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1037 mode.
1038
1039 @item -batch-silent
1040 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1041 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1042 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1043 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1044 for an interactive session.
1045
1046 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1047 messages, for example.
1048
1049 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1050 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1051
1052 @item -return-child-result
1053 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1054 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1055 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1056
1057 @itemize @bullet
1058 @item
1059 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1060 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1061 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1062 @item
1063 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1064 @item
1065 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1066 the exit code will be -1.
1067 @end itemize
1068
1069 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1070 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1071 interface.
1072
1073 @item -nowindows
1074 @itemx -nw
1075 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1076 @cindex @code{-nw}
1077 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1078 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1079 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1080
1081 @item -windows
1082 @itemx -w
1083 @cindex @code{--windows}
1084 @cindex @code{-w}
1085 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1086 used if possible.
1087
1088 @item -cd @var{directory}
1089 @cindex @code{--cd}
1090 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1091 instead of the current directory.
1092
1093 @item -fullname
1094 @itemx -f
1095 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1096 @cindex @code{-f}
1097 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1098 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1099 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1100 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1101 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1102 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1103 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1104 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1105 frame.
1106
1107 @item -epoch
1108 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1109 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1110 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1111 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1112 separate window.
1113
1114 @item -annotate @var{level}
1115 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1116 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1117 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1118 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1119 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1120 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1121 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1122 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1123 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1124
1125 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1126 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1127
1128 @item --args
1129 @cindex @code{--args}
1130 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1131 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1132 This option stops option processing.
1133
1134 @item -baud @var{bps}
1135 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1136 @cindex @code{--baud}
1137 @cindex @code{-b}
1138 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1139 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -l @var{timeout}
1142 @cindex @code{-l}
1143 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1144 for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -tty @var{device}
1147 @itemx -t @var{device}
1148 @cindex @code{--tty}
1149 @cindex @code{-t}
1150 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1151 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1152
1153 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1154 @item -tui
1155 @cindex @code{--tui}
1156 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1157 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1158 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1159 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1160 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1161 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1162 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1163
1164 @c @item -xdb
1165 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1166 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1167 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1168 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1169 @c systems.
1170
1171 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1172 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1173 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1174 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1175 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1176 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1177
1178 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1179 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1180 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1181 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1182 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1183 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1184
1185 @item -write
1186 @cindex @code{--write}
1187 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1188 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1189 (@pxref{Patching}).
1190
1191 @item -statistics
1192 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1194 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1195
1196 @item -version
1197 @cindex @code{--version}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1199 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1200
1201 @end table
1202
1203 @node Startup
1204 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1205 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1206
1207 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1208
1209 @enumerate
1210 @item
1211 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1212 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1213
1214 @item
1215 @cindex init file
1216 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1217 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1218 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1219 that file.
1220
1221 @item
1222 Processes command line options and operands.
1223
1224 @item
1225 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1226 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1227 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1228 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1229 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1230 @value{GDBN}.
1231
1232 @item
1233 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1234 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1235
1236 @item
1237 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1238 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1239 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1240 @end enumerate
1241
1242 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1243 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1244 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1245 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1246 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1247 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1248
1249 @cindex init file name
1250 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1251 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1252 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1253 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1254 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1255 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1256 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1257 the file to the standard name.
1258
1259
1260 @node Quitting GDB
1261 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1262 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1263 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1264
1265 @table @code
1266 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1267 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1268 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1269 @itemx q
1270 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1271 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1272 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1273 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1274 error code.
1275 @end table
1276
1277 @cindex interrupt
1278 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1279 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1280 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1281 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1282 until a time when it is safe.
1283
1284 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1285 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1286 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1287
1288 @node Shell Commands
1289 @section Shell Commands
1290
1291 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1292 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1293 just use the @code{shell} command.
1294
1295 @table @code
1296 @kindex shell
1297 @cindex shell escape
1298 @item shell @var{command string}
1299 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1300 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1301 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1302 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1303 @end table
1304
1305 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1306 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1307 @value{GDBN}:
1308
1309 @table @code
1310 @kindex make
1311 @cindex calling make
1312 @item make @var{make-args}
1313 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1314 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1315 @end table
1316
1317 @node Logging Output
1318 @section Logging Output
1319 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1320 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1321
1322 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1323 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1324
1325 @table @code
1326 @kindex set logging
1327 @item set logging on
1328 Enable logging.
1329 @item set logging off
1330 Disable logging.
1331 @cindex logging file name
1332 @item set logging file @var{file}
1333 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1334 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1335 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1336 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1337 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1338 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1339 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1340 @kindex show logging
1341 @item show logging
1342 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1343 @end table
1344
1345 @node Commands
1346 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1347
1348 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1349 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1350 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1351 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1352 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1353
1354 @menu
1355 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1356 * Completion:: Command completion
1357 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1358 @end menu
1359
1360 @node Command Syntax
1361 @section Command Syntax
1362
1363 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1364 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1365 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1366 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1367 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1368 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1369
1370 @cindex abbreviation
1371 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1372 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1373 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1374 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1375 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1376 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1377 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1378
1379 @cindex repeating commands
1380 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1381 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1382 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1383 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1384 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1385 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1386 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1387
1388 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1389 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1390 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1391
1392 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1393 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1394 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1395 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1396 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1397
1398 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1399 @cindex comment
1400 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1401 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1402 Files,,Command Files}).
1403
1404 @cindex repeating command sequences
1405 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1406 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1407 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1408 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1409 for editing.
1410
1411 @node Completion
1412 @section Command Completion
1413
1414 @cindex completion
1415 @cindex word completion
1416 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1417 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1418 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1419 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1420
1421 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1422 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1423 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1424 enter it). For example, if you type
1425
1426 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1427 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1428 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1429 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1430 @smallexample
1431 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1432 @end smallexample
1433
1434 @noindent
1435 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1436 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1437
1438 @smallexample
1439 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1440 @end smallexample
1441
1442 @noindent
1443 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1444 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1445 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1446 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1447 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1448 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1449
1450 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1451 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1452 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1453 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1454 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1455 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1456 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1457 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1458 example:
1459
1460 @smallexample
1461 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1462 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1463 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1464 make_abs_section make_function_type
1465 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1466 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1467 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1468 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1469 @end smallexample
1470
1471 @noindent
1472 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1473 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1474 command.
1475
1476 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1477 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1478 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1479 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1480 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1481
1482 @cindex quotes in commands
1483 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1484 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1485 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1486 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1487 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1488 @value{GDBN} commands.
1489
1490 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1491 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1492 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1493 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1494 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1495 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1496 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1497 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1498 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1499 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1500 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1501
1502 @smallexample
1503 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1504 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1505 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1506 @end smallexample
1507
1508 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1509 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1510 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1511 place:
1512
1513 @smallexample
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1515 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1516 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1517 @end smallexample
1518
1519 @noindent
1520 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1521 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1522 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1523
1524 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1525 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1526 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1527 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1528
1529
1530 @node Help
1531 @section Getting Help
1532 @cindex online documentation
1533 @kindex help
1534
1535 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1536 using the command @code{help}.
1537
1538 @table @code
1539 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1540 @item help
1541 @itemx h
1542 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1543 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1544
1545 @smallexample
1546 (@value{GDBP}) help
1547 List of classes of commands:
1548
1549 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1550 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1551 data -- Examining data
1552 files -- Specifying and examining files
1553 internals -- Maintenance commands
1554 obscure -- Obscure features
1555 running -- Running the program
1556 stack -- Examining the stack
1557 status -- Status inquiries
1558 support -- Support facilities
1559 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1560 stopping the program
1561 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1562
1563 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1564 commands in that class.
1565 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1566 documentation.
1567 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1568 (@value{GDBP})
1569 @end smallexample
1570 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1571
1572 @item help @var{class}
1573 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1574 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1575 help display for the class @code{status}:
1576
1577 @smallexample
1578 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1579 Status inquiries.
1580
1581 List of commands:
1582
1583 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1584 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1585 info -- Generic command for showing things
1586 about the program being debugged
1587 show -- Generic command for showing things
1588 about the debugger
1589
1590 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1591 documentation.
1592 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1593 (@value{GDBP})
1594 @end smallexample
1595
1596 @item help @var{command}
1597 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1598 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1599
1600 @kindex apropos
1601 @item apropos @var{args}
1602 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1603 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1604 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1605
1606 @smallexample
1607 apropos reload
1608 @end smallexample
1609
1610 @noindent
1611 results in:
1612
1613 @smallexample
1614 @c @group
1615 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1616 multiple times in one run
1617 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1618 multiple times in one run
1619 @c @end group
1620 @end smallexample
1621
1622 @kindex complete
1623 @item complete @var{args}
1624 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1625 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1626 command you want completed. For example:
1627
1628 @smallexample
1629 complete i
1630 @end smallexample
1631
1632 @noindent results in:
1633
1634 @smallexample
1635 @group
1636 if
1637 ignore
1638 info
1639 inspect
1640 @end group
1641 @end smallexample
1642
1643 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1644 @end table
1645
1646 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1647 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1648 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1649 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1650 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1651 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1652
1653 @c @group
1654 @table @code
1655 @kindex info
1656 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1657 @item info
1658 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1659 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1660 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1661 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1662 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1663 @w{@code{help info}}.
1664
1665 @kindex set
1666 @item set
1667 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1668 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1669 @code{set prompt $}.
1670
1671 @kindex show
1672 @item show
1673 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1674 @value{GDBN} itself.
1675 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1676 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1677 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1678 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1679
1680 @kindex info set
1681 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1682 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1683 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1684 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1685 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1686 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1687 @end table
1688 @c @end group
1689
1690 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1691 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1692
1693 @table @code
1694 @kindex show version
1695 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1696 @item show version
1697 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1698 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1699 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1700 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1701 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1702 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1703 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1704 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1705 @value{GDBN}.
1706
1707 @kindex show copying
1708 @kindex info copying
1709 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1710 @item show copying
1711 @itemx info copying
1712 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1713
1714 @kindex show warranty
1715 @kindex info warranty
1716 @item show warranty
1717 @itemx info warranty
1718 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1719 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1720
1721 @end table
1722
1723 @node Running
1724 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1725
1726 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1727 debugging information when you compile it.
1728
1729 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1730 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1731 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1732 kill a child process.
1733
1734 @menu
1735 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1736 * Starting:: Starting your program
1737 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1738 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1739
1740 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1741 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1742 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1743 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1744
1745 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1746 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1747 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1748 @end menu
1749
1750 @node Compilation
1751 @section Compiling for Debugging
1752
1753 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1754 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1755 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1756 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1757 and addresses in the executable code.
1758
1759 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1760 the compiler.
1761
1762 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1763 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1764 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1765 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1766 executables containing debugging information.
1767
1768 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1769 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1770 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1771 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1772 in pushing your luck.
1773
1774 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1775 @cindex debugging optimized code
1776 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1777 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1778 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1779 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1780 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1781 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1782
1783 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1784 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1785 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1786 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1787 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1788
1789 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1790 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1791 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1792
1793 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1794 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1795 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1796 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1797 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1798 provides macro information if you specify the options
1799 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1800 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1801 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1802 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1803 @option{-g} alone.
1804
1805 @need 2000
1806 @node Starting
1807 @section Starting your Program
1808 @cindex starting
1809 @cindex running
1810
1811 @table @code
1812 @kindex run
1813 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1814 @item run
1815 @itemx r
1816 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1817 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1818 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1819 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1820 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1821
1822 @end table
1823
1824 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1825 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1826 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1827 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1828
1829 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1830 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1831 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1832 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1833 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1834 divided into four categories:
1835
1836 @table @asis
1837 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1838 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1839 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1840 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1841 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1842 the arguments.
1843 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1844 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1845 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1846
1847 @item The @emph{environment.}
1848 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1849 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1850 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1851 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1854 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1855 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1856 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1857
1858 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1859 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1860 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1861 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1862 set a different device for your program.
1863 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1864
1865 @cindex pipes
1866 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1867 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1868 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1869 wrong program.
1870 @end table
1871
1872 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1873 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1874 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1875 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1876 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1877
1878 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1879 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1880 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1881 your current breakpoints.
1882
1883 @table @code
1884 @kindex start
1885 @item start
1886 @cindex run to main procedure
1887 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1888 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1889 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1890 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1891 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1892 procedure, depending on the language used.
1893
1894 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1895 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1896 the @samp{run} command.
1897
1898 @cindex elaboration phase
1899 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1900 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1901 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1902 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1903 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1904 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1905 will remain to halt execution.
1906
1907 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1908 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1909 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1910 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1911 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1912
1913 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1914 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1915 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1916 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1917 elaboration code before running your program.
1918 @end table
1919
1920 @node Arguments
1921 @section Your Program's Arguments
1922
1923 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1924 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1925 @code{run} command.
1926 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1927 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1928 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1929 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1930 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1931
1932 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1933 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1934 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1935 the program, not by the shell.
1936
1937 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1938 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1939
1940 @table @code
1941 @kindex set args
1942 @item set args
1943 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1944 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1945 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1946 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1947 it again without arguments.
1948
1949 @kindex show args
1950 @item show args
1951 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1952 @end table
1953
1954 @node Environment
1955 @section Your Program's Environment
1956
1957 @cindex environment (of your program)
1958 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1959 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1960 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1961 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1962 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1963 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1964 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1965
1966 @table @code
1967 @kindex path
1968 @item path @var{directory}
1969 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1970 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1971 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1972 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1973 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1974 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1975 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1976
1977 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1978 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1979 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1980 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1981 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1982 @var{directory} to the search path.
1983 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1984 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1985
1986 @kindex show paths
1987 @item show paths
1988 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1989 environment variable).
1990
1991 @kindex show environment
1992 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1993 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1994 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1995 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1996 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1997
1998 @kindex set environment
1999 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2000 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2001 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2002 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2003 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2004 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2005 null value.
2006 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2007 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2008
2009 For example, this command:
2010
2011 @smallexample
2012 set env USER = foo
2013 @end smallexample
2014
2015 @noindent
2016 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2017 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2018 are not actually required.)
2019
2020 @kindex unset environment
2021 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2022 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2023 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2024 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2025 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2026 @end table
2027
2028 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2029 the shell indicated
2030 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2031 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2032 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2033 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2034 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2035 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2036 @file{.profile}.
2037
2038 @node Working Directory
2039 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2040
2041 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2042 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2043 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2044 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2045 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2046 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2047
2048 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2049 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2050 Specify Files}.
2051
2052 @table @code
2053 @kindex cd
2054 @cindex change working directory
2055 @item cd @var{directory}
2056 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2057
2058 @kindex pwd
2059 @item pwd
2060 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2061 @end table
2062
2063 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2064 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2065 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2066 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2067 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2068 current working directory of the debuggee.
2069
2070 @node Input/Output
2071 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2072
2073 @cindex redirection
2074 @cindex i/o
2075 @cindex terminal
2076 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2077 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2078 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2079 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2080 running your program.
2081
2082 @table @code
2083 @kindex info terminal
2084 @item info terminal
2085 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2086 program is using.
2087 @end table
2088
2089 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2090 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2091
2092 @smallexample
2093 run > outfile
2094 @end smallexample
2095
2096 @noindent
2097 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2098
2099 @kindex tty
2100 @cindex controlling terminal
2101 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2102 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2103 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2104 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2105 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2106
2107 @smallexample
2108 tty /dev/ttyb
2109 @end smallexample
2110
2111 @noindent
2112 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2113 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2114 that as their controlling terminal.
2115
2116 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2117 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2118 terminal.
2119
2120 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2121 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2122 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2123 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2124
2125 @cindex inferior tty
2126 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2127 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2128 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2129 program.
2130
2131 @table @code
2132 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2133 @kindex set inferior-tty
2134 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2135
2136 @item show inferior-tty
2137 @kindex show inferior-tty
2138 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2139 @end table
2140
2141 @node Attach
2142 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2143 @kindex attach
2144 @cindex attach
2145
2146 @table @code
2147 @item attach @var{process-id}
2148 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2149 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2150 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2151 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2152 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2153
2154 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2155 executing the command.
2156 @end table
2157
2158 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2159 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2160 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2161 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2162
2163 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2164 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2165 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2166 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2167 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2168 Specify Files}.
2169
2170 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2171 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2172 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2173 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2174 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2175 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2176 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2177
2178 @table @code
2179 @kindex detach
2180 @item detach
2181 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2182 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2183 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2184 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2185 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2186 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2187 executing the command.
2188 @end table
2189
2190 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2191 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2192 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2193 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2194 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2195 Messages}).
2196
2197 @node Kill Process
2198 @section Killing the Child Process
2199
2200 @table @code
2201 @kindex kill
2202 @item kill
2203 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2204 @end table
2205
2206 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2207 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2208 is running.
2209
2210 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2211 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2212 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2213 outside the debugger.
2214
2215 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2216 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2217 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2218 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2219 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2220 breakpoint settings).
2221
2222 @node Threads
2223 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2224
2225 @cindex threads of execution
2226 @cindex multiple threads
2227 @cindex switching threads
2228 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2229 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2230 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2231 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2232 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2233 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2234 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2235
2236 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2237 programs:
2238
2239 @itemize @bullet
2240 @item automatic notification of new threads
2241 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2242 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2243 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2244 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2245 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2246 @end itemize
2247
2248 @quotation
2249 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2250 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2251 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2252 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2253 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2254 like this:
2255
2256 @smallexample
2257 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2258 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2259 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2260 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2261 @end smallexample
2262 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2263 @c doesn't support threads"?
2264 @end quotation
2265
2266 @cindex focus of debugging
2267 @cindex current thread
2268 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2269 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2270 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2271 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2272 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2273
2274 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2275 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2276 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2277 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2278 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2279 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2280 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2281 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2282 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2283 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2284
2285 @smallexample
2286 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2287 @end smallexample
2288
2289 @noindent
2290 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2291 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2292 further qualifier.
2293
2294 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2295 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2296 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2297 @c program?
2298 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2299 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2300 @c threads ab initio?
2301
2302 @cindex thread number
2303 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2304 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2305 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2306
2307 @table @code
2308 @kindex info threads
2309 @item info threads
2310 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2311 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2312
2313 @enumerate
2314 @item
2315 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2316
2317 @item
2318 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2319
2320 @item
2321 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2322 @end enumerate
2323
2324 @noindent
2325 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2326 indicates the current thread.
2327
2328 For example,
2329 @end table
2330 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2331
2332 @smallexample
2333 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2334 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2335 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2336 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2337 at threadtest.c:68
2338 @end smallexample
2339
2340 On HP-UX systems:
2341
2342 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2343 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2344 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2345 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2346 thread in your program.
2347
2348 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2349 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2350 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2351 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2352 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2353 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2354 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2355 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2356 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2357 HP-UX, you see
2358
2359 @smallexample
2360 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2361 @end smallexample
2362
2363 @noindent
2364 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2365
2366 @table @code
2367 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2368 @item info threads
2369 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2370 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2371
2372 @enumerate
2373 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2374
2375 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2376
2377 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2378 @end enumerate
2379
2380 @noindent
2381 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2382 indicates the current thread.
2383
2384 For example,
2385 @end table
2386 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2387
2388 @smallexample
2389 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2390 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2391 at quicksort.c:137
2392 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2393 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2394 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2395 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2396 @end smallexample
2397
2398 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2399 Solaris-specific command:
2400
2401 @table @code
2402 @item maint info sol-threads
2403 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2404 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2405 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 @table @code
2409 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2410 @item thread @var{threadno}
2411 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2412 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2413 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2414 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2415 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2416
2417 @smallexample
2418 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2419 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2420 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2421 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2422 @end smallexample
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2426 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2427 threads.
2428
2429 @kindex thread apply
2430 @cindex apply command to several threads
2431 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2432 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2433 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2434 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2435 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2436 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2437 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2438 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2439 @end table
2440
2441 @cindex automatic thread selection
2442 @cindex switching threads automatically
2443 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2444 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2445 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2446 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2447 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2448 thread.
2449
2450 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2451 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2452 programs with multiple threads.
2453
2454 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2455 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2456
2457 @node Processes
2458 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2459
2460 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2461 @cindex multiple processes
2462 @cindex processes, multiple
2463 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2464 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2465 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2466 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2467 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2468 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2469 will cause it to terminate.
2470
2471 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2472 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2473 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2474 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2475 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2476 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2477 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2478 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2479 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2480 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2481
2482 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2483 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2484 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2485 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2486
2487 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2488 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2489
2490 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2491 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2492
2493 @table @code
2494 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2495 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2496 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2497 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2498 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2499
2500 @table @code
2501 @item parent
2502 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2503 unimpeded. This is the default.
2504
2505 @item child
2506 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2507 unimpeded.
2508
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2512 @item show follow-fork-mode
2513 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2514 @end table
2515
2516 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2517 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2518 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2519
2520 @table @code
2521 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2522 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2523 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2524 retain debugger control over them both.
2525
2526 @table @code
2527 @item on
2528 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2529 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2530 independently. This is the default.
2531
2532 @item off
2533 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2534 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2535 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2536 is held suspended.
2537
2538 @end table
2539
2540 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2541 @item show detach-on-follow
2542 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2543 @end table
2544
2545 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2546 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2547 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2548 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2549 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2550
2551 @table @code
2552 @kindex info forks
2553 @item info forks
2554 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2555 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2556 position (program counter) of the process.
2557
2558
2559 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2560 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2561 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2562 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2563 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2564
2565 @end table
2566
2567 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2568 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2569 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2570 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2571
2572 @table @code
2573 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2574 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2575 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2576 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2577 allowed to run independently.
2578
2579 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2580 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2581 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2582 and remove it from the fork list.
2583
2584 @end table
2585
2586 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2587 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2588 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2589 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2590 the child process's @code{main}.
2591
2592 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2593 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2594
2595 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2596 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2597 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2598 argument.
2599
2600 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2601 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2602 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2603
2604 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2605 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2606
2607 @cindex checkpoint
2608 @cindex restart
2609 @cindex bookmark
2610 @cindex snapshot of a process
2611 @cindex rewind program state
2612
2613 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2614 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2615 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2616 later.
2617
2618 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2619 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2620 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2621 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2622 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2623
2624 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2625 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2626 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2627 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2628 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2629 start again from there.
2630
2631 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2632 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2633
2634 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2635
2636 @table @code
2637 @kindex checkpoint
2638 @item checkpoint
2639 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2640 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2641 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2642
2643 @kindex info checkpoints
2644 @item info checkpoints
2645 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2646 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2647 listed:
2648
2649 @table @code
2650 @item Checkpoint ID
2651 @item Process ID
2652 @item Code Address
2653 @item Source line, or label
2654 @end table
2655
2656 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2657 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2658 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2659 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2660 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2661 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2662 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2663
2664 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2665 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2666 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2667 the debugger.
2668
2669 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2670 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2671 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2672
2673 @end table
2674
2675 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2676 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2677 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2678 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2679 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2680 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2681 previously read data can be read again.
2682
2683 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2684 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2685 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2686 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2687 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2688 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2689
2690 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2691 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2692 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2693 different execution path this time.
2694
2695 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2696 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2697 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2698 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2699 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2700 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2701 potentially pose a problem.
2702
2703 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2704
2705 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2706 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2707 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2708 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2709 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2710 next.
2711
2712 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2713 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2714 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2715 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2716 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2717
2718 @node Stopping
2719 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2720
2721 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2722 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2723 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2724
2725 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2726 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2727 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2728 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2729 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2730 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2731 explicitly request this information at any time.
2732
2733 @table @code
2734 @kindex info program
2735 @item info program
2736 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2737 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2738 @end table
2739
2740 @menu
2741 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2742 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2743 * Signals:: Signals
2744 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2745 @end menu
2746
2747 @node Breakpoints
2748 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2749
2750 @cindex breakpoints
2751 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2752 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2753 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2754 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2755 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2756 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2757 program.
2758
2759 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2760 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2761 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2762 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2763 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2764 call).
2765
2766 @cindex watchpoints
2767 @cindex data breakpoints
2768 @cindex memory tracing
2769 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2770 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2771 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2772 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2773 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2774 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2775 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2776 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2777 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2778 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2779 same commands.
2780
2781 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2782 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2783 Automatic Display}.
2784
2785 @cindex catchpoints
2786 @cindex breakpoint on events
2787 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2788 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2789 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2790 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2791 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2792 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2793 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2794
2795 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2796 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2797 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2798 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2799 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2800 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2801 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2802 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2803 enable it again.
2804
2805 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2806 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2807 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2808 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2809 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2810 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2811 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2812
2813 @menu
2814 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2815 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2816 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2817 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2818 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2819 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2820 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2821 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2822 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2823 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2824 @end menu
2825
2826 @node Set Breaks
2827 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2828
2829 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2830 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2831 @c
2832 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2833
2834 @kindex break
2835 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2836 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2837 @cindex latest breakpoint
2838 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2839 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2840 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2841 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2842 convenience variables.
2843
2844 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @item break @var{function}
2848 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2849 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2850 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2851 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2852
2853 @item break +@var{offset}
2854 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2855 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2856 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2857 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2858
2859 @item break @var{linenum}
2860 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2861 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2862 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2863 code on that line.
2864
2865 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2866 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2867
2868 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2869 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2870 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2871 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2872 functions.
2873
2874 @item break *@var{address}
2875 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2876 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2877 information or source files.
2878
2879 @item break
2880 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2881 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2882 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2883 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2884 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2885 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2886 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2887 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2888 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2889 inside loops.
2890
2891 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2892 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2893 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2894 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2895 existed when your program stopped.
2896
2897 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2898 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2899 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2900 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2901 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2902 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2903 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2904
2905 @kindex tbreak
2906 @item tbreak @var{args}
2907 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2908 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2909 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2910 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2911
2912 @kindex hbreak
2913 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2914 @item hbreak @var{args}
2915 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2916 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2917 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2918 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2919 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2920 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2921 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2922 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2923 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2924 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2925 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2926 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2927 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2928 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2929 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2930 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2931 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2932 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2933
2934
2935 @kindex thbreak
2936 @item thbreak @var{args}
2937 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2938 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2939 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2940 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2941 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2942 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2943 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2944 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2945
2946 @kindex rbreak
2947 @cindex regular expression
2948 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2949 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2950 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2951 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2952 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2953 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2954 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2955 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2956 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2957
2958 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2959 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2960 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2961 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2962 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2963 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2964
2965 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2966 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2967 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2968 classes.
2969
2970 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2971 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2972 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @kindex info breakpoints
2979 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2980 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2981 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2982 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2983 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2984 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2985 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2986 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2987
2988 @table @emph
2989 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2990 @item Type
2991 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2992 @item Disposition
2993 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2994 @item Enabled or Disabled
2995 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2996 that are not enabled.
2997 @item Address
2998 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2999 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3000 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3001 @item What
3002 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3003 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3004 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3005 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3006 @end table
3007
3008 @noindent
3009 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3010 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3011 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3012 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3013 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3014 valid location.
3015
3016 @noindent
3017 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3018 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3019 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3020 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3021 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3022
3023 @noindent
3024 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3025 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3026 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3027 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3028 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3029 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3030 @end table
3031
3032 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3033 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3034 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3035 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3036
3037 @cindex pending breakpoints
3038 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3039 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3040 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3041 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3042 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3043 gets loaded.
3044
3045 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3046 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3047 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3048 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3049 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3050 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3051
3052 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3053 breakpoint support:
3054
3055 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3056 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3057 @table @code
3058 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3059 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3060 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3061
3062 @item set breakpoint pending on
3063 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3064 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3065
3066 @item set breakpoint pending off
3067 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3068 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3069 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3070
3071 @item show breakpoint pending
3072 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3073 @end table
3074
3075 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3076 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3077 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3078 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3079 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3080 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3081 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3082 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3083 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3084 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3085 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3086 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3087 of these loads could resolve the location.
3088
3089 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3090 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3091 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3092 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3093 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3094 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3095 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3096 breakpoints.
3097
3098 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3099
3100 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3101 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3102 @table @code
3103 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3104 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3105 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3106 breakpoint must be used.
3107
3108 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3109 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3110 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3111 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3112 @end table
3113
3114
3115 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3116 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3117 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3118 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3119 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3120 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3121 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3122 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3123
3124
3125 @node Set Watchpoints
3126 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3127
3128 @cindex setting watchpoints
3129 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3130 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3131 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3132 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3133 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3134
3135 @itemize @bullet
3136 @item
3137 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3138
3139 @item
3140 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3141 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3142 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3143
3144 @item
3145 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3146 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3147 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3148 @end itemize
3149
3150 @cindex software watchpoints
3151 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3152 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3153 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3154 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3155 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3156 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3157 culprit.)
3158
3159 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3160 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3161 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3162
3163 @table @code
3164 @kindex watch
3165 @item watch @var{expr}
3166 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3167 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3168 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3169 to watch the value of a single variable:
3170
3171 @smallexample
3172 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @kindex rwatch
3176 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3177 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3178 by the program.
3179
3180 @kindex awatch
3181 @item awatch @var{expr}
3182 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3183 or written into by the program.
3184
3185 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3186 @item info watchpoints
3187 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3188 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3189 @end table
3190
3191 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3192 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3193 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3194 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3195 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3196 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3197
3198 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3199 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3200 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3201 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3202 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3203 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3204 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3205 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3206
3207 @table @code
3208 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3209 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3210 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3211
3212 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3213 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3214 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3218 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3219 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3220
3221 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3222
3223 @smallexample
3224 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3225 @end smallexample
3226
3227 @noindent
3228 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3229
3230 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3231 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3232 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3233 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3234 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3235 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3236 will print a message like this:
3237
3238 @smallexample
3239 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3240 @end smallexample
3241
3242 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3243 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3244 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3245 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3246 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3247 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3248 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3249 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3250
3251 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3252 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3253 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3254 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3255 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3256 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3257
3258 @smallexample
3259 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3260 @end smallexample
3261
3262 @noindent
3263 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3264
3265 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3266 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3267 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3268 expression with separately allocated resources.
3269
3270 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3271 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3272 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3273 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3274 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3275 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3276 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3277 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3278 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3279 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3280
3281 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3282 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3283 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3284
3285 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3286 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3287 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3288 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3289 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3290 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3291 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3292 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3293 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3294
3295 @quotation
3296 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3297 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3298 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3299 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3300 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3301 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3302 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3303 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3304 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3305 the expression.
3306
3307 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3308 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3309 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3310 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3311 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3312 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3313 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3314 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3315 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3316 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3317 @end quotation
3318
3319 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3320
3321 @node Set Catchpoints
3322 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3323 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3324 @cindex exception handlers
3325 @cindex event handling
3326
3327 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3328 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3329 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3330
3331 @table @code
3332 @kindex catch
3333 @item catch @var{event}
3334 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3335 @table @code
3336 @item throw
3337 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3338 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3339
3340 @item catch
3341 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3342
3343 @item exception
3344 @cindex Ada exception catching
3345 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3346 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3347 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3348 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3349 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3350
3351 @item exception unhandled
3352 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3353
3354 @item assert
3355 A failed Ada assertion.
3356
3357 @item exec
3358 @cindex break on fork/exec
3359 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3360
3361 @item fork
3362 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3363
3364 @item vfork
3365 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3366
3367 @item load
3368 @itemx load @var{libname}
3369 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3370 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3371 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3372
3373 @item unload
3374 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3375 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3376 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3377 @end table
3378
3379 @item tcatch @var{event}
3380 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3381 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3382
3383 @end table
3384
3385 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3386
3387 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3388 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3389
3390 @itemize @bullet
3391 @item
3392 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3393 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3394 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3395 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3396 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3397 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3398 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3399 disabled within interactive calls.
3400
3401 @item
3402 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3403
3404 @item
3405 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3406 @end itemize
3407
3408 @cindex raise exceptions
3409 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3410 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3411 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3412 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3413 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3414 out where the exception was raised.
3415
3416 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3417 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3418 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3419 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3420
3421 @smallexample
3422 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3423 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3424 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3425 @end smallexample
3426
3427 @noindent
3428 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3429 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3430 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3431
3432 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3433 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3434 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3435 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3436 raised.
3437
3438
3439 @node Delete Breaks
3440 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3441
3442 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3443 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3444 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3445 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3446 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3447 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3448
3449 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3450 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3451 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3452 their breakpoint numbers.
3453
3454 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3455 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3456 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3457
3458 @table @code
3459 @kindex clear
3460 @item clear
3461 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3462 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3463 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3464 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3465
3466 @item clear @var{function}
3467 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3468 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3469
3470 @item clear @var{linenum}
3471 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3472 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3473 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3474
3475 @cindex delete breakpoints
3476 @kindex delete
3477 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3478 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3479 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3480 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3481 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3482 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3483 @end table
3484
3485 @node Disabling
3486 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3487
3488 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3489 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3490 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3491 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3492 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3493
3494 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3495 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3496 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3497 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3498 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3499
3500 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3501 states of enablement:
3502
3503 @itemize @bullet
3504 @item
3505 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3506 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3507 @item
3508 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3509 @item
3510 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3511 disabled.
3512 @item
3513 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3514 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3515 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3516 @end itemize
3517
3518 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3519 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3520
3521 @table @code
3522 @kindex disable
3523 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3524 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3525 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3526 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3527 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3528 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3529 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3530
3531 @kindex enable
3532 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3533 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3534 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3535
3536 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3537 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3538 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3539
3540 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3541 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3542 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3543 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3544 @end table
3545
3546 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3547 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3548 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3549 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3550 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3551 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3552 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3553 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3554 Stepping}.)
3555
3556 @node Conditions
3557 @subsection Break Conditions
3558 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3559 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3560
3561 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3562 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3563 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3564 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3565 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3566 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3567 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3568 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3569
3570 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3571 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3572 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3573 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3574 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3575
3576 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3577 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3578 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3579 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3580 one.
3581
3582 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3583 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3584 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3585 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3586 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3587 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3588 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3589 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3590 conditions for the
3591 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3592 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3593
3594 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3595 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3596 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3597 with the @code{condition} command.
3598
3599 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3600 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3601 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3602 catchpoint.
3603
3604 @table @code
3605 @kindex condition
3606 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3607 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3608 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3609 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3610 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3611 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3612 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3613 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3614 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3615 prints an error message:
3616
3617 @smallexample
3618 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3619 @end smallexample
3620
3621 @noindent
3622 @value{GDBN} does
3623 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3624 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3625 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3626
3627 @item condition @var{bnum}
3628 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3629 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3630 @end table
3631
3632 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3633 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3634 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3635 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3636 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3637 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3638 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3639 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3640 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3641 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3642 your program reaches it.
3643
3644 @table @code
3645 @kindex ignore
3646 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3647 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3648 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3649 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3650 takes no action.
3651
3652 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3653 a count of zero.
3654
3655 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3656 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3657 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3658 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3659
3660 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3661 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3662 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3663
3664 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3665 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3666 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3667 Variables}.
3668 @end table
3669
3670 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3671
3672
3673 @node Break Commands
3674 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3675
3676 @cindex breakpoint commands
3677 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3678 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3679 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3680 enable other breakpoints.
3681
3682 @table @code
3683 @kindex commands
3684 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3685 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3686 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3687 @itemx end
3688 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3689 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3690 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3691
3692 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3693 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3694
3695 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3696 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3697 recently encountered).
3698 @end table
3699
3700 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3701 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3702
3703 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3704 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3705 that resumes execution.
3706
3707 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3708 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3709 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3710 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3711 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3712
3713 @kindex silent
3714 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3715 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3716 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3717 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3718 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3719 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3720
3721 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3722 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3723 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3724
3725 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3726 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3727
3728 @smallexample
3729 break foo if x>0
3730 commands
3731 silent
3732 printf "x is %d\n",x
3733 cont
3734 end
3735 @end smallexample
3736
3737 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3738 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3739 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3740 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3741 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3742 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3743 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 break 403
3747 commands
3748 silent
3749 set x = y + 4
3750 cont
3751 end
3752 @end smallexample
3753
3754 @node Breakpoint Menus
3755 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3756 @cindex overloading
3757 @cindex symbol overloading
3758
3759 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3760 single function name
3761 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3762 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3763 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3764 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3765 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3766 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3767 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3768 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3769 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3770 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3771 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3772 breakpoints.
3773
3774 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3775 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3776 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3777
3778 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3779 @smallexample
3780 @group
3781 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3782 [0] cancel
3783 [1] all
3784 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3785 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3786 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3787 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3788 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3789 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3790 > 2 4 6
3791 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3792 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3793 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3794 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3795 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3796 breakpoints.
3797 (@value{GDBP})
3798 @end group
3799 @end smallexample
3800
3801 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3802 @node Error in Breakpoints
3803 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3804 @c
3805 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3806 @c
3807 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3808 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3809 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3810 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3811
3812 @smallexample
3813 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3814 The same program may be running in another process.
3815 @end smallexample
3816
3817 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3818
3819 @enumerate
3820 @item
3821 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3822
3823 @item
3824 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3825 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3826 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3827 Then start your program again.
3828
3829 @item
3830 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3831 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3832 to nonsharable executables.
3833 @end enumerate
3834 @c @end ifclear
3835
3836 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3837 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3838
3839 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3840 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3841 @smallexample
3842 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3843 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3844 @end smallexample
3845
3846 @noindent
3847 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3848 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3849 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3850
3851 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3852 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3853
3854 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3855 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3856 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3857
3858 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3859 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3860 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3861 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3862
3863 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3864 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3865 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3866 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3867 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3868 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3869 first in the bundle.
3870
3871 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3872 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3873 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3874 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3875 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3876 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3877 is hit.
3878
3879 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3880 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3881
3882 @smallexample
3883 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3884 @end smallexample
3885
3886 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3887 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3888 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3889 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3890 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3891 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3892 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3893 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3894
3895 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3896 adjusted breakpoints:
3897
3898 @smallexample
3899 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3900 to 0x00010410.
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3904 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3905 frequently than expected.
3906
3907 @node Continuing and Stepping
3908 @section Continuing and Stepping
3909
3910 @cindex stepping
3911 @cindex continuing
3912 @cindex resuming execution
3913 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3914 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3915 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3916 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3917 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3918 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3919 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3920 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3921
3922 @table @code
3923 @kindex continue
3924 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3925 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3926 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3927 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3928 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3929 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3930 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3931 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3932 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3933 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3934
3935 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3936 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3937 @code{continue} is ignored.
3938
3939 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3940 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3941 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3942 @code{continue}.
3943 @end table
3944
3945 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3946 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
3947 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3948 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3949
3950 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3951 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
3952 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3953 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3954 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3955 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3956
3957 @table @code
3958 @kindex step
3959 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3960 @item step
3961 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3962 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3963 abbreviated @code{s}.
3964
3965 @quotation
3966 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3967 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3968 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3969 @c distinction here.
3970 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3971 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3972 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3973 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3974 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3975 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3976 below.
3977 @end quotation
3978
3979 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3980 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3981 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3982 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3983 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3984 called within the line.
3985
3986 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3987 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3988 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3989 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3990 was any debugging information about the routine.
3991
3992 @item step @var{count}
3993 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3994 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3995 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3996
3997 @kindex next
3998 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3999 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4000 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4001 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4002 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4003 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4004 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4005 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4006
4007 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4008
4009
4010 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4011 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4012 @c
4013 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4014 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4015 @c function are executed without stopping.
4016
4017 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4018 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4019 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4020
4021 @kindex set step-mode
4022 @item set step-mode
4023 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4024 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4025 @itemx set step-mode on
4026 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4027 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4028 information rather than stepping over it.
4029
4030 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4031 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4032 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4033
4034 @item set step-mode off
4035 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4036 debug information. This is the default.
4037
4038 @item show step-mode
4039 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4040 source line debug information.
4041
4042 @kindex finish
4043 @item finish
4044 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4045 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4046
4047 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4048 ,Returning from a Function}).
4049
4050 @kindex until
4051 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4052 @cindex run until specified location
4053 @item until
4054 @itemx u
4055 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4056 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4057 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4058 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4059 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4060 than the address of the jump.
4061
4062 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4063 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4064 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4065 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4066 through the next iteration.
4067
4068 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4069 stack frame.
4070
4071 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4072 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4073 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4074 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4075 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4076
4077 @smallexample
4078 (@value{GDBP}) f
4079 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4080 206 expand_input();
4081 (@value{GDBP}) until
4082 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4083 @end smallexample
4084
4085 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4086 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4087 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4088 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4089 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4090 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4091 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4092
4093 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4094 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4095 argument.
4096
4097 @item until @var{location}
4098 @itemx u @var{location}
4099 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4100 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4101 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4102 ,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4103 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4104 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4105 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4106 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4107 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4108 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4109 invocations have returned.
4110
4111 @smallexample
4112 94 int factorial (int value)
4113 95 @{
4114 96 if (value > 1) @{
4115 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4116 98 @}
4117 99 return (value);
4118 100 @}
4119 @end smallexample
4120
4121
4122 @kindex advance @var{location}
4123 @itemx advance @var{location}
4124 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4125 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4126 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4127 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4128 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4129 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4130
4131
4132 @kindex stepi
4133 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4134 @item stepi
4135 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4136 @itemx si
4137 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4138
4139 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4140 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4141 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4142 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4143
4144 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4145
4146 @need 750
4147 @kindex nexti
4148 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4149 @item nexti
4150 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4151 @itemx ni
4152 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4153 proceed until the function returns.
4154
4155 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4156 @end table
4157
4158 @node Signals
4159 @section Signals
4160 @cindex signals
4161
4162 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4163 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4164 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4165 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4166 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4167 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4168 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4169 requested an alarm).
4170
4171 @cindex fatal signals
4172 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4173 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4174 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4175 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4176 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4177 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4178
4179 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4180 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4181 signal.
4182
4183 @cindex handling signals
4184 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4185 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4186 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4187 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4188 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4189
4190 @table @code
4191 @kindex info signals
4192 @kindex info handle
4193 @item info signals
4194 @itemx info handle
4195 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4196 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4197 the defined types of signals.
4198
4199 @item info signals @var{sig}
4200 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4201
4202 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4203
4204 @kindex handle
4205 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4206 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4207 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4208 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4209 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4210 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4211 say what change to make.
4212 @end table
4213
4214 @c @group
4215 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4216 Their full names are:
4217
4218 @table @code
4219 @item nostop
4220 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4221 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4222
4223 @item stop
4224 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4225 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4226
4227 @item print
4228 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4229
4230 @item noprint
4231 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4232 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4233
4234 @item pass
4235 @itemx noignore
4236 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4237 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4238 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4239
4240 @item nopass
4241 @itemx ignore
4242 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4243 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4244 @end table
4245 @c @end group
4246
4247 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4248 program until you
4249 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4250 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4251 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4252 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4253 program sees that signal when you continue.
4254
4255 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4256 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4257 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4258 erroneous signals.
4259
4260 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4261 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4262 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4263 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4264 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4265 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4266 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4267 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4268 Program a Signal}.
4269
4270 @node Thread Stops
4271 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4272
4273 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4274 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4275 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4276
4277 @table @code
4278 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4279 @cindex thread breakpoints
4280 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4281 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4282 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4283 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4284 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4285
4286 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4287 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4288 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4289 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4290 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4291
4292 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4293 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4294 program.
4295
4296 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4297 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4298 breakpoint condition, like this:
4299
4300 @smallexample
4301 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4302 @end smallexample
4303
4304 @end table
4305
4306 @cindex stopped threads
4307 @cindex threads, stopped
4308 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4309 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4310 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4311 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4312 underfoot.
4313
4314 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4315 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4316 @cindex premature return from system calls
4317 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4318 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4319 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4320 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4321 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4322 stop execution.
4323
4324 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4325 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4326 style anyways.
4327
4328 For example, do not write code like this:
4329
4330 @smallexample
4331 sleep (10);
4332 @end smallexample
4333
4334 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4335 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4336
4337 Instead, write this:
4338
4339 @smallexample
4340 int unslept = 10;
4341 while (unslept > 0)
4342 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4346 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4347 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4348 @value{GDBN}.
4349
4350 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4351 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4352 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4353 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4354
4355 @cindex continuing threads
4356 @cindex threads, continuing
4357 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4358 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4359 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4360
4361 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4362 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4363 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4364 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4365 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4366 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4367 stops.
4368
4369 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4370 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4371 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4372 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4373
4374 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4375 thread to run.
4376
4377 @table @code
4378 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4379 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4380 @cindex lock scheduler
4381 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4382 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4383 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4384 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4385 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4386 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4387 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4388 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4389 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4390 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4391 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4392
4393 @item show scheduler-locking
4394 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4395 @end table
4396
4397
4398 @node Stack
4399 @chapter Examining the Stack
4400
4401 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4402 stopped and how it got there.
4403
4404 @cindex call stack
4405 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4406 is generated.
4407 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4408 the arguments of the call,
4409 and the local variables of the function being called.
4410 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4411 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4412 stack}.
4413
4414 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4415 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4416
4417 @cindex selected frame
4418 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4419 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4420 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4421 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4422 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4423 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4424
4425 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4426 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4427 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4428
4429 @menu
4430 * Frames:: Stack frames
4431 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4432 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4433 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4434
4435 @end menu
4436
4437 @node Frames
4438 @section Stack Frames
4439
4440 @cindex frame, definition
4441 @cindex stack frame
4442 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4443 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4444 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4445 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4446 which the function is executing.
4447
4448 @cindex initial frame
4449 @cindex outermost frame
4450 @cindex innermost frame
4451 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4452 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4453 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4454 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4455 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4456 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4457 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4458 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4459
4460 @cindex frame pointer
4461 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4462 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4463 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4464 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4465 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4466 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4467
4468 @cindex frame number
4469 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4470 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4471 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4472 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4473 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4474
4475 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4476 @c underflow problems.
4477 @cindex frameless execution
4478 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4479 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4480 @smallexample
4481 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4482 @end smallexample
4483 generates functions without a frame.)
4484 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4485 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4486 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4487 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4488 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4489 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4490 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4491
4492 @table @code
4493 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4494 @cindex current stack frame
4495 @item frame @var{args}
4496 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4497 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4498 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4499 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4500
4501 @kindex select-frame
4502 @cindex selecting frame silently
4503 @item select-frame
4504 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4505 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4506 @code{frame}.
4507 @end table
4508
4509 @node Backtrace
4510 @section Backtraces
4511
4512 @cindex traceback
4513 @cindex call stack traces
4514 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4515 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4516 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4517 stack.
4518
4519 @table @code
4520 @kindex backtrace
4521 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4522 @item backtrace
4523 @itemx bt
4524 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4525 frames in the stack.
4526
4527 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4528 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4529
4530 @item backtrace @var{n}
4531 @itemx bt @var{n}
4532 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4533
4534 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4535 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4536 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4537
4538 @item backtrace full
4539 @itemx bt full
4540 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4541 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4542 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4543 number of frames to print, as described above.
4544 @end table
4545
4546 @kindex where
4547 @kindex info stack
4548 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4549 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4550
4551 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4552 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4553 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4554 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4555 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4556 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4557 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4558 multi-threaded program.
4559
4560 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4561 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4562 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4563 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4564 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4565 line number.
4566
4567 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4568 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4569
4570 @smallexample
4571 @group
4572 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4573 at builtin.c:993
4574 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4575 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4576 at macro.c:71
4577 (More stack frames follow...)
4578 @end group
4579 @end smallexample
4580
4581 @noindent
4582 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4583 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4584 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4585
4586 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4587 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4588 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4589 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4590 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4591 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4592 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4593 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4594 such a backtrace might look like:
4595
4596 @smallexample
4597 @group
4598 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4599 at builtin.c:993
4600 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4601 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4602 at macro.c:71
4603 (More stack frames follow...)
4604 @end group
4605 @end smallexample
4606
4607 @noindent
4608 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4609 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4610
4611 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4612 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4613 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4614
4615 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4616 @cindex program entry point
4617 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4618 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4619 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4620 @code{main}@footnote{
4621 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4622 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4623 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4624 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4625 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4626 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4627
4628 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4629 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4630
4631 @table @code
4632 @item set backtrace past-main
4633 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4634 @kindex set backtrace
4635 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4636
4637 @item set backtrace past-main off
4638 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4639 default.
4640
4641 @item show backtrace past-main
4642 @kindex show backtrace
4643 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4644
4645 @item set backtrace past-entry
4646 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4647 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4648 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4649 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4650
4651 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4652 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4653 application. This is the default.
4654
4655 @item show backtrace past-entry
4656 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4657
4658 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4659 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4660 @cindex backtrace limit
4661 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4662 unlimited.
4663
4664 @item show backtrace limit
4665 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4666 @end table
4667
4668 @node Selection
4669 @section Selecting a Frame
4670
4671 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4672 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4673 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4674 of the stack frame just selected.
4675
4676 @table @code
4677 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4678 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4679 @item frame @var{n}
4680 @itemx f @var{n}
4681 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4682 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4683 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4684 @code{main}.
4685
4686 @item frame @var{addr}
4687 @itemx f @var{addr}
4688 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4689 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4690 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4691 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4692 switches between them.
4693
4694 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4695 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4696
4697 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4698 pointer and a program counter.
4699
4700 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4701 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4702
4703 @kindex up
4704 @item up @var{n}
4705 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4706 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4707 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4708
4709 @kindex down
4710 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4711 @item down @var{n}
4712 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4713 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4714 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4715 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4716 @end table
4717
4718 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4719 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4720 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4721 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4722
4723 @need 1000
4724 For example:
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 @group
4728 (@value{GDBP}) up
4729 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4730 at env.c:10
4731 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4732 @end group
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4736 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4737 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4738 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4739 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4740 for details.
4741
4742 @table @code
4743 @kindex down-silently
4744 @kindex up-silently
4745 @item up-silently @var{n}
4746 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4747 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4748 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4749 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4750 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4751 distracting.
4752 @end table
4753
4754 @node Frame Info
4755 @section Information About a Frame
4756
4757 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4758 stack frame.
4759
4760 @table @code
4761 @item frame
4762 @itemx f
4763 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4764 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4765 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4766 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4767 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4768
4769 @kindex info frame
4770 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4771 @item info frame
4772 @itemx info f
4773 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4774 including:
4775
4776 @itemize @bullet
4777 @item
4778 the address of the frame
4779 @item
4780 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4781 @item
4782 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4783 @item
4784 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4785 @item
4786 the address of the frame's arguments
4787 @item
4788 the address of the frame's local variables
4789 @item
4790 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4791 @item
4792 which registers were saved in the frame
4793 @end itemize
4794
4795 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4796 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4797 the usual conventions.
4798
4799 @item info frame @var{addr}
4800 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4801 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4802 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4803 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4804 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4805 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4806
4807 @kindex info args
4808 @item info args
4809 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4810
4811 @item info locals
4812 @kindex info locals
4813 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4814 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4815 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4816
4817 @kindex info catch
4818 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4819 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4820 @item info catch
4821 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4822 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4823 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4824 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4825 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4826
4827 @end table
4828
4829
4830 @node Source
4831 @chapter Examining Source Files
4832
4833 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4834 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4835 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4836 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4837 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4838 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4839 source files by explicit command.
4840
4841 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4842 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4843 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4844
4845 @menu
4846 * List:: Printing source lines
4847 * Edit:: Editing source files
4848 * Search:: Searching source files
4849 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4850 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4851 @end menu
4852
4853 @node List
4854 @section Printing Source Lines
4855
4856 @kindex list
4857 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4858 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4859 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4860 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4861
4862 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4863
4864 @table @code
4865 @item list @var{linenum}
4866 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4867 current source file.
4868
4869 @item list @var{function}
4870 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4871 @var{function}.
4872
4873 @item list
4874 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4875 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4876 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4877 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4878 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4879
4880 @item list -
4881 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4882 @end table
4883
4884 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4885 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4886 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4887
4888 @table @code
4889 @kindex set listsize
4890 @item set listsize @var{count}
4891 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4892 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4893
4894 @kindex show listsize
4895 @item show listsize
4896 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4897 @end table
4898
4899 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4900 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4901 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4902 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4903 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4904
4905 @cindex linespec
4906 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4907 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4908 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4909 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4910
4911 @table @code
4912 @item list @var{linespec}
4913 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4914
4915 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4916 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4917 linespecs.
4918
4919 @item list ,@var{last}
4920 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4921
4922 @item list @var{first},
4923 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4924
4925 @item list +
4926 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4927
4928 @item list -
4929 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4930
4931 @item list
4932 As described in the preceding table.
4933 @end table
4934
4935 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4936 kinds of linespec.
4937
4938 @table @code
4939 @item @var{number}
4940 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4941 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4942 the same source file as the first linespec.
4943
4944 @item +@var{offset}
4945 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4946 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4947 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4948 first linespec.
4949
4950 @item -@var{offset}
4951 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4952
4953 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4954 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4955
4956 @item @var{function}
4957 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4958 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4959
4960 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4961 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4962 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4963 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4964 identically named functions in different source files.
4965
4966 @item *@var{address}
4967 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4968 @var{address} may be any expression.
4969 @end table
4970
4971 @node Edit
4972 @section Editing Source Files
4973 @cindex editing source files
4974
4975 @kindex edit
4976 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4977 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4978 The editing program of your choice
4979 is invoked with the current line set to
4980 the active line in the program.
4981 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4982 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4983
4984 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4985
4986 @table @code
4987 @item edit
4988 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4989
4990 @item edit @var{number}
4991 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4992
4993 @item edit @var{function}
4994 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4995
4996 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4997 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4998
4999 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5000 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5001 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5002 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5003 identically named functions in different source files.
5004
5005 @item edit *@var{address}
5006 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5007 @var{address} may be any expression.
5008 @end table
5009
5010 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5011 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5012 @footnote{
5013 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5014 following command-line syntax:
5015 @smallexample
5016 ex +@var{number} file
5017 @end smallexample
5018 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5019 the file where to start editing.}.
5020 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5021 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5022 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5023 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5024 @smallexample
5025 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5026 export EDITOR
5027 gdb @dots{}
5028 @end smallexample
5029 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5030 @smallexample
5031 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5032 gdb @dots{}
5033 @end smallexample
5034
5035 @node Search
5036 @section Searching Source Files
5037 @cindex searching source files
5038
5039 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5040 regular expression.
5041
5042 @table @code
5043 @kindex search
5044 @kindex forward-search
5045 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5046 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5047 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5048 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5049 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5050 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5051 @code{fo}.
5052
5053 @kindex reverse-search
5054 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5055 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5056 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5057 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5058 this command as @code{rev}.
5059 @end table
5060
5061 @node Source Path
5062 @section Specifying Source Directories
5063
5064 @cindex source path
5065 @cindex directories for source files
5066 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5067 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5068 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5069 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5070 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5071 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5072 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5073
5074 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5075 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5076 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5077 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5078 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5079 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5080 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5081 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5082 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5083 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5084 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5085
5086 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5087 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5088 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5089 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5090 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5091 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5092
5093 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5094 source files.
5095
5096 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5097 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5098 each line is in the file.
5099
5100 @kindex directory
5101 @kindex dir
5102 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5103 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5104 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5105
5106 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5107 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5108
5109 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5110 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5111 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5112 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5113 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5114 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5115 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5116 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5117 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5118 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5119 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5120 name to look up the sources.
5121
5122 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5123 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5124 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5125 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5126 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5127 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5128 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5129 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5130
5131 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5132 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5133 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5134 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5135 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5136 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5137 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5138
5139 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5140 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5141 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5142 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5143 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5144 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5145 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5146 command.
5147
5148 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5149 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5150 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5151 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5152 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5153 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5154 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5155
5156 @table @code
5157 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5158 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5159 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5160 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5161 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5162 part of absolute file names) or
5163 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5164 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5165
5166 @kindex cdir
5167 @kindex cwd
5168 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5169 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5170 @cindex compilation directory
5171 @cindex current directory
5172 @cindex working directory
5173 @cindex directory, current
5174 @cindex directory, compilation
5175 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5176 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5177 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5178 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5179 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5180 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5181
5182 @item directory
5183 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5184
5185 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5186 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5187
5188 @item show directories
5189 @kindex show directories
5190 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5191
5192 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5193 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5194 @kindex set substitute-path
5195 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5196 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5197 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5198
5199 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5200 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5201
5202 @smallexample
5203 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5204 @end smallexample
5205
5206 @noindent
5207 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5208 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5209 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5210
5211 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5212 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5213 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5214 the substitution.
5215
5216 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5217
5218 @smallexample
5219 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5220 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5221 @end smallexample
5222
5223 @noindent
5224 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5225 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5226 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5227 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5228
5229
5230 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5231 @kindex unset substitute-path
5232 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5233 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5234 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5235
5236 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5237
5238 @item show substitute-path [path]
5239 @kindex show substitute-path
5240 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5241 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5242
5243 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5244 rules.
5245
5246 @end table
5247
5248 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5249 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5250 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5251
5252 @enumerate
5253 @item
5254 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5255
5256 @item
5257 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5258 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5259 directories in one command.
5260 @end enumerate
5261
5262 @node Machine Code
5263 @section Source and Machine Code
5264 @cindex source line and its code address
5265
5266 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5267 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5268 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5269 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5270 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5271 well as hex.
5272
5273 @table @code
5274 @kindex info line
5275 @item info line @var{linespec}
5276 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5277 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5278 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5279 Source Lines}).
5280 @end table
5281
5282 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5283 the object code for the first line of function
5284 @code{m4_changequote}:
5285
5286 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5287 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5288 @smallexample
5289 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5290 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5291 @end smallexample
5292
5293 @noindent
5294 @cindex code address and its source line
5295 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5296 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5297 @smallexample
5298 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5299 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5300 @end smallexample
5301
5302 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5303 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5304 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5305 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5306 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5307 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5308 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5309 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5310 Variables}).
5311
5312 @table @code
5313 @kindex disassemble
5314 @cindex assembly instructions
5315 @cindex instructions, assembly
5316 @cindex machine instructions
5317 @cindex listing machine instructions
5318 @item disassemble
5319 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5320 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5321 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5322 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5323 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5324 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5325 @end table
5326
5327 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5328 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5329
5330 @smallexample
5331 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5332 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5333 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5334 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5335 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5336 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5337 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5338 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5339 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5340 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5341 End of assembler dump.
5342 @end smallexample
5343
5344 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5345 mnemonics or other syntax.
5346
5347 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5348 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5349 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5350 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5351 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5352
5353 @table @code
5354 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5355 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5356 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5357 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5358 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5359 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5360
5361 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5362 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5363 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5364 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5365
5366 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5367 @item show disassembly-flavor
5368 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5369 @end table
5370
5371
5372 @node Data
5373 @chapter Examining Data
5374
5375 @cindex printing data
5376 @cindex examining data
5377 @kindex print
5378 @kindex inspect
5379 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5380 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5381 @c different window or something like that.
5382 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5383 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5384 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5385 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5386 Different Languages}).
5387
5388 @table @code
5389 @item print @var{expr}
5390 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5391 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5392 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5393 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5394 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5395 Formats}.
5396
5397 @item print
5398 @itemx print /@var{f}
5399 @cindex reprint the last value
5400 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5401 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5402 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5403 @end table
5404
5405 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5406 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5407 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5408
5409 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5410 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5411 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5412 Table}.
5413
5414 @menu
5415 * Expressions:: Expressions
5416 * Variables:: Program variables
5417 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5418 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5419 * Memory:: Examining memory
5420 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5421 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5422 * Value History:: Value history
5423 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5424 * Registers:: Registers
5425 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5426 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5427 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5428 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5429 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5430 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5431 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5432 character set than GDB does
5433 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5434 @end menu
5435
5436 @node Expressions
5437 @section Expressions
5438
5439 @cindex expressions
5440 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5441 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5442 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5443 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5444 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5445 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5446 @ref{Compilation}.
5447
5448 @cindex arrays in expressions
5449 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5450 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5451 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5452 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5453
5454 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5455 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5456 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5457 languages.
5458
5459 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5460 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5461
5462 @cindex casts, in expressions
5463 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5464 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5465 at that address in memory.
5466 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5467
5468 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5469 to programming languages:
5470
5471 @table @code
5472 @item @@
5473 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5474 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5475
5476 @item ::
5477 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5478 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5479
5480 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5481 @cindex type casting memory
5482 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5483 @cindex casts, to view memory
5484 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5485 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5486 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5487 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5488 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5489 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5490 @end table
5491
5492 @node Variables
5493 @section Program Variables
5494
5495 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5496 in your program.
5497
5498 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5499 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5500
5501 @itemize @bullet
5502 @item
5503 global (or file-static)
5504 @end itemize
5505
5506 @noindent or
5507
5508 @itemize @bullet
5509 @item
5510 visible according to the scope rules of the
5511 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5512 @end itemize
5513
5514 @noindent This means that in the function
5515
5516 @smallexample
5517 foo (a)
5518 int a;
5519 @{
5520 bar (a);
5521 @{
5522 int b = test ();
5523 bar (b);
5524 @}
5525 @}
5526 @end smallexample
5527
5528 @noindent
5529 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5530 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5531 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5532 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5533
5534 @cindex variable name conflict
5535 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5536 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5537 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5538 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5539 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5540 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5541 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5542
5543 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5544 @ifnotinfo
5545 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5546 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5547 @end ifnotinfo
5548 @smallexample
5549 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5550 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5551 @end smallexample
5552
5553 @noindent
5554 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5555 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5556 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5557 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5558
5559 @smallexample
5560 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5561 @end smallexample
5562
5563 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5564 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5565 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5566 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5567 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5568 @c conflict?? --mew
5569
5570 @cindex wrong values
5571 @cindex variable values, wrong
5572 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5573 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5574 @quotation
5575 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5576 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5577 scope, and just before exit.
5578 @end quotation
5579 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5580 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5581 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5582 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5583 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5584 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5585 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5586 variable definitions may be gone.
5587
5588 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5589 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5590 when compiling.
5591
5592 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5593 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5594 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5595 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5596 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5597 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5598 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5599
5600 @smallexample
5601 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5602 @end smallexample
5603
5604 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5605 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5606 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5607 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5608 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5609 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5610 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5611 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5612 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5613 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5614 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5615
5616 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5617 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5618 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5619 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5620
5621 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5622 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5623 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5624 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5625 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5626 For program code
5627
5628 @smallexample
5629 char var0[] = "A";
5630 signed char var1[] = "A";
5631 @end smallexample
5632
5633 You get during debugging
5634 @smallexample
5635 (gdb) print var0
5636 $1 = "A"
5637 (gdb) print var1
5638 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5639 @end smallexample
5640
5641 @node Arrays
5642 @section Artificial Arrays
5643
5644 @cindex artificial array
5645 @cindex arrays
5646 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5647 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5648 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5649 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5650 program.
5651
5652 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5653 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5654 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5655 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5656 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5657 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5658 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5659 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5660 example. If a program says
5661
5662 @smallexample
5663 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5664 @end smallexample
5665
5666 @noindent
5667 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5668
5669 @smallexample
5670 p *array@@len
5671 @end smallexample
5672
5673 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5674 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5675 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5676 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5677 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5678
5679 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5680 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5681 The value need not be in memory:
5682 @smallexample
5683 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5684 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5685 @end smallexample
5686
5687 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5688 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5689 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5690 @smallexample
5691 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5692 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5693 @end smallexample
5694
5695 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5696 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5697 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5698 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5699 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5700 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5701 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5702 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5703 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5704 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5705
5706 @smallexample
5707 set $i = 0
5708 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5709 @key{RET}
5710 @key{RET}
5711 @dots{}
5712 @end smallexample
5713
5714 @node Output Formats
5715 @section Output Formats
5716
5717 @cindex formatted output
5718 @cindex output formats
5719 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5720 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5721 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5722 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5723 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5724
5725 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5726 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5727 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5728 letters supported are:
5729
5730 @table @code
5731 @item x
5732 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5733 hexadecimal.
5734
5735 @item d
5736 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5737
5738 @item u
5739 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5740
5741 @item o
5742 Print as integer in octal.
5743
5744 @item t
5745 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5746 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5747 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5748 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5749
5750 @item a
5751 @cindex unknown address, locating
5752 @cindex locate address
5753 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5754 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5755 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5756
5757 @smallexample
5758 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5759 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5760 @end smallexample
5761
5762 @noindent
5763 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5764 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5765
5766 @item c
5767 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5768 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5769 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5770 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5771
5772 @item f
5773 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5774 using typical floating point syntax.
5775 @end table
5776
5777 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5778
5779 @smallexample
5780 p/x $pc
5781 @end smallexample
5782
5783 @noindent
5784 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5785 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5786
5787 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5788 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5789 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5790
5791 @node Memory
5792 @section Examining Memory
5793
5794 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5795 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5796
5797 @cindex examining memory
5798 @table @code
5799 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5800 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5801 @itemx x @var{addr}
5802 @itemx x
5803 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5804 @end table
5805
5806 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5807 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5808 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5809 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5810 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5811
5812 @table @r
5813 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5814 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5815 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5816 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5817 @c 4.1.2.
5818
5819 @item @var{f}, the display format
5820 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5821 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5822 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5823 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5824 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5825 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5826
5827 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5828 The unit size is any of
5829
5830 @table @code
5831 @item b
5832 Bytes.
5833 @item h
5834 Halfwords (two bytes).
5835 @item w
5836 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5837 @item g
5838 Giant words (eight bytes).
5839 @end table
5840
5841 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5842 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5843 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5844
5845 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5846 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5847 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5848 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5849 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5850 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5851 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5852 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5853 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5854 a value from memory).
5855 @end table
5856
5857 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5858 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5859 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5860 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5861 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5862
5863 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5864 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5865 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5866 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5867 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5868
5869 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5870 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5871 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5872 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5873 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5874 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5875 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5876 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5877 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5878
5879 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5880 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5881 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5882 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5883 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5884 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5885 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5886
5887 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5888 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5889 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5890 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5891 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5892 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5893 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5894 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5895 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5896
5897 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5898 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5899 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5900
5901 @cindex remote memory comparison
5902 @cindex verify remote memory image
5903 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5904 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5905 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5906 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5907 situations.
5908
5909 @table @code
5910 @kindex compare-sections
5911 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5912 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5913 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5914 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5915 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5916 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5917 remote request.
5918 @end table
5919
5920 @node Auto Display
5921 @section Automatic Display
5922 @cindex automatic display
5923 @cindex display of expressions
5924
5925 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5926 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5927 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5928 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5929 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5930 The automatic display looks like this:
5931
5932 @smallexample
5933 2: foo = 38
5934 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5935 @end smallexample
5936
5937 @noindent
5938 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5939 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5940 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5941 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5942 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5943 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5944 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @kindex display
5948 @item display @var{expr}
5949 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5950 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5951
5952 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5953
5954 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5955 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5956 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5957 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5958 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
5959
5960 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5961 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5962 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5963 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5964 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5965 @end table
5966
5967 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5968 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5969 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5970
5971 @table @code
5972 @kindex delete display
5973 @kindex undisplay
5974 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5975 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5976 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5977
5978 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5979 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5980
5981 @kindex disable display
5982 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5983 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5984 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5985 enabled again later.
5986
5987 @kindex enable display
5988 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5989 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5990 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5991
5992 @item display
5993 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5994 done when your program stops.
5995
5996 @kindex info display
5997 @item info display
5998 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5999 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6000 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6001 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6002 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6003 @end table
6004
6005 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6006 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6007 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6008 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6009 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6010 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6011 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6012 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6013 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6014 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6015 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6016
6017 @node Print Settings
6018 @section Print Settings
6019
6020 @cindex format options
6021 @cindex print settings
6022 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6023 and symbols are printed.
6024
6025 @noindent
6026 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6027
6028 @table @code
6029 @kindex set print
6030 @item set print address
6031 @itemx set print address on
6032 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6033 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6034 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6035 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6036 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6037 @code{set print address on}:
6038
6039 @smallexample
6040 @group
6041 (@value{GDBP}) f
6042 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6043 at input.c:530
6044 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6045 @end group
6046 @end smallexample
6047
6048 @item set print address off
6049 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6050 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6051
6052 @smallexample
6053 @group
6054 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6055 (@value{GDBP}) f
6056 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6057 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6058 @end group
6059 @end smallexample
6060
6061 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6062 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6063 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6064 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6065
6066 @kindex show print
6067 @item show print address
6068 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6069 @end table
6070
6071 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6072 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6073 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6074 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6075 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6076 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6077 it prints a symbolic address:
6078
6079 @table @code
6080 @item set print symbol-filename on
6081 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6082 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6083 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6084 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6085
6086 @item set print symbol-filename off
6087 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6088 default.
6089
6090 @item show print symbol-filename
6091 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6092 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6093 @end table
6094
6095 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6096 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6097 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6098
6099 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6100 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6101
6102 @table @code
6103 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6104 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6105 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6106 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6107 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6108 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6109
6110 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6111 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6112 symbolic address.
6113 @end table
6114
6115 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6116 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6117 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6118 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6119 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6120 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6121 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6122 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6123
6124 @smallexample
6125 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6126 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6127 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6128 @end smallexample
6129
6130 @quotation
6131 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6132 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6133 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6134 @end quotation
6135
6136 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6137
6138 @table @code
6139 @item set print array
6140 @itemx set print array on
6141 @cindex pretty print arrays
6142 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6143 but uses more space. The default is off.
6144
6145 @item set print array off
6146 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6147
6148 @item show print array
6149 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6150 arrays.
6151
6152 @cindex print array indexes
6153 @item set print array-indexes
6154 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6155 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6156 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6157 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6158
6159 @item set print array-indexes off
6160 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6161
6162 @item show print array-indexes
6163 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6164 arrays.
6165
6166 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6167 @cindex number of array elements to print
6168 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6169 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6170 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6171 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6172 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6173 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6174 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6175
6176 @item show print elements
6177 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6178 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6179
6180 @item set print repeats
6181 @cindex repeated array elements
6182 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6183 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6184 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6185 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6186 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6187 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6188 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6189
6190 @item show print repeats
6191 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6192 elements.
6193
6194 @item set print null-stop
6195 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6196 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6197 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6198 contain only short strings.
6199 The default is off.
6200
6201 @item show print null-stop
6202 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6203 @sc{null} character.
6204
6205 @item set print pretty on
6206 @cindex print structures in indented form
6207 @cindex indentation in structure display
6208 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6209 per line, like this:
6210
6211 @smallexample
6212 @group
6213 $1 = @{
6214 next = 0x0,
6215 flags = @{
6216 sweet = 1,
6217 sour = 1
6218 @},
6219 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6220 @}
6221 @end group
6222 @end smallexample
6223
6224 @item set print pretty off
6225 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6226
6227 @smallexample
6228 @group
6229 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6230 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6231 @end group
6232 @end smallexample
6233
6234 @noindent
6235 This is the default format.
6236
6237 @item show print pretty
6238 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6239
6240 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6241 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6242 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6243 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6244 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6245 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6246 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6247 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6248
6249 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6250 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6251 international character sets, and is the default.
6252
6253 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6254 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6255
6256 @item set print union on
6257 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6258 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6259 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6260
6261 @item set print union off
6262 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6263 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6264 instead.
6265
6266 @item show print union
6267 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6268 structures and other unions.
6269
6270 For example, given the declarations
6271
6272 @smallexample
6273 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6274 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6275 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6276 Bug_forms;
6277
6278 struct thing @{
6279 Species it;
6280 union @{
6281 Tree_forms tree;
6282 Bug_forms bug;
6283 @} form;
6284 @};
6285
6286 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6287 @end smallexample
6288
6289 @noindent
6290 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6291
6292 @smallexample
6293 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6294 @end smallexample
6295
6296 @noindent
6297 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6298
6299 @smallexample
6300 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6301 @end smallexample
6302
6303 @noindent
6304 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6305 and in Pascal.
6306 @end table
6307
6308 @need 1000
6309 @noindent
6310 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6311
6312 @table @code
6313 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6314 @item set print demangle
6315 @itemx set print demangle on
6316 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6317 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6318 linkage. The default is on.
6319
6320 @item show print demangle
6321 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6322
6323 @item set print asm-demangle
6324 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6325 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6326 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6327 The default is off.
6328
6329 @item show print asm-demangle
6330 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6331 or demangled form.
6332
6333 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6334 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6335 @kindex set demangle-style
6336 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6337 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6338 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6339
6340 @table @code
6341 @item auto
6342 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6343
6344 @item gnu
6345 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6346 This is the default.
6347
6348 @item hp
6349 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6350
6351 @item lucid
6352 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6353
6354 @item arm
6355 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6356 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6357 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6358 require further enhancement to permit that.
6359
6360 @end table
6361 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6362
6363 @item show demangle-style
6364 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6365
6366 @item set print object
6367 @itemx set print object on
6368 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6369 @cindex display derived types
6370 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6371 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6372 the virtual function table.
6373
6374 @item set print object off
6375 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6376 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6377
6378 @item show print object
6379 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6380
6381 @item set print static-members
6382 @itemx set print static-members on
6383 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6384 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6385
6386 @item set print static-members off
6387 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6388
6389 @item show print static-members
6390 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6391
6392 @item set print pascal_static-members
6393 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6394 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6395 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6396 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6397
6398 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6399 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6400
6401 @item show print pascal_static-members
6402 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6403
6404 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6405 @item set print vtbl
6406 @itemx set print vtbl on
6407 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6408 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6409 @cindex VTBL display
6410 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6411 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6412 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6413
6414 @item set print vtbl off
6415 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6416
6417 @item show print vtbl
6418 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6419 @end table
6420
6421 @node Value History
6422 @section Value History
6423
6424 @cindex value history
6425 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6426 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6427 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6428 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6429 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6430 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6431 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6432 symbol table.
6433
6434 @cindex @code{$}
6435 @cindex @code{$$}
6436 @cindex history number
6437 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6438 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6439 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6440 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6441 history number.
6442
6443 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6444 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6445 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6446 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6447 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6448 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6449 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6450
6451 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6452 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6453
6454 @smallexample
6455 p *$
6456 @end smallexample
6457
6458 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6459 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6460
6461 @smallexample
6462 p *$.next
6463 @end smallexample
6464
6465 @noindent
6466 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6467 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6468
6469 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6470 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6471
6472 @smallexample
6473 print x
6474 set x=5
6475 @end smallexample
6476
6477 @noindent
6478 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6479 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6480
6481 @table @code
6482 @kindex show values
6483 @item show values
6484 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6485 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6486 values} does not change the history.
6487
6488 @item show values @var{n}
6489 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6490
6491 @item show values +
6492 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6493 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6494 @end table
6495
6496 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6497 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6498
6499 @node Convenience Vars
6500 @section Convenience Variables
6501
6502 @cindex convenience variables
6503 @cindex user-defined variables
6504 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6505 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6506 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6507 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6508 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6509
6510 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6511 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6512 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6513 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6514 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6515
6516 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6517 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6518 For example:
6519
6520 @smallexample
6521 set $foo = *object_ptr
6522 @end smallexample
6523
6524 @noindent
6525 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6526 @code{object_ptr}.
6527
6528 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6529 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6530 value with another assignment at any time.
6531
6532 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6533 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6534 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6535 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6536
6537 @table @code
6538 @kindex show convenience
6539 @cindex show all user variables
6540 @item show convenience
6541 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6542 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6543
6544 @kindex init-if-undefined
6545 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6546 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6547 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6548 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6549 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6550 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6551 override default values used in a command script.
6552
6553 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6554 any side-effects do not occur.
6555 @end table
6556
6557 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6558 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6559 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6560
6561 @smallexample
6562 set $i = 0
6563 print bar[$i++]->contents
6564 @end smallexample
6565
6566 @noindent
6567 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6568
6569 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6570 values likely to be useful.
6571
6572 @table @code
6573 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6574 @item $_
6575 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6576 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6577 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6578 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6579 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6580 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6581 to the type of @code{$__}.
6582
6583 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6584 @item $__
6585 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6586 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6587 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6588
6589 @item $_exitcode
6590 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6591 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6592 the program being debugged terminates.
6593 @end table
6594
6595 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6596 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6597 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6598
6599 @node Registers
6600 @section Registers
6601
6602 @cindex registers
6603 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6604 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6605 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6606 your machine.
6607
6608 @table @code
6609 @kindex info registers
6610 @item info registers
6611 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6612 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6613
6614 @kindex info all-registers
6615 @cindex floating point registers
6616 @item info all-registers
6617 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6618 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6619
6620 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6621 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6622 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6623 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6624 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6625 @end table
6626
6627 @cindex stack pointer register
6628 @cindex program counter register
6629 @cindex process status register
6630 @cindex frame pointer register
6631 @cindex standard registers
6632 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6633 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6634 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6635 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6636 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6637 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6638 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6639 you could print the program counter in hex with
6640
6641 @smallexample
6642 p/x $pc
6643 @end smallexample
6644
6645 @noindent
6646 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6647
6648 @smallexample
6649 x/i $pc
6650 @end smallexample
6651
6652 @noindent
6653 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6654 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6655 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6656 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6657 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6658 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6659 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6660
6661 @smallexample
6662 set $sp += 4
6663 @end smallexample
6664
6665 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6666 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6667 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6668 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6669 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6670 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6671 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6672
6673 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6674 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6675 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6676 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6677 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6678 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6679 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6680
6681 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6682 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6683 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6684 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6685 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6686 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6687 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6688 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6689 prints the data in both formats.
6690
6691 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6692 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6693 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6694 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6695 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6696 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6697 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6698
6699 @smallexample
6700 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6701 $1 = @{
6702 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6703 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6704 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6705 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6706 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6707 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6708 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6709 @}
6710 @end smallexample
6711
6712 @noindent
6713 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6714 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6715 value to a @code{struct} member:
6716
6717 @smallexample
6718 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6719 @end smallexample
6720
6721 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6722 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6723 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6724 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6725 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6726 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6727
6728 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6729 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6730 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6731 frame makes no difference.
6732
6733 @node Floating Point Hardware
6734 @section Floating Point Hardware
6735 @cindex floating point
6736
6737 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6738 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6739
6740 @table @code
6741 @kindex info float
6742 @item info float
6743 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6744 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6745 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6746 the ARM and x86 machines.
6747 @end table
6748
6749 @node Vector Unit
6750 @section Vector Unit
6751 @cindex vector unit
6752
6753 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6754 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6755
6756 @table @code
6757 @kindex info vector
6758 @item info vector
6759 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6760 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6761 @end table
6762
6763 @node OS Information
6764 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6765 @cindex OS information
6766
6767 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6768 you debug your program.
6769
6770 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6771 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6772 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6773 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6774 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6775 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6776 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6777 structure.
6778
6779 @table @code
6780 @item info udot
6781 @kindex info udot
6782 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6783 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6784 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6785 the @code{examine} command.
6786 @end table
6787
6788 @cindex auxiliary vector
6789 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6790 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6791 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6792 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6793 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6794 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6795 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6796 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6797 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6798 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6799 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6800 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6801
6802 @table @code
6803 @kindex info auxv
6804 @item info auxv
6805 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6806 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6807 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6808 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6809 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6810 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6811 an unrecognized tag.
6812 @end table
6813
6814
6815 @node Memory Region Attributes
6816 @section Memory Region Attributes
6817 @cindex memory region attributes
6818
6819 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6820 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6821 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6822 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6823 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6824 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6825 user can override the fetched regions.
6826
6827 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6828 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6829 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6830 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6831 all memory.
6832
6833 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6834 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6835
6836 @table @code
6837 @kindex mem
6838 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6839 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6840 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6841 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6842 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6843 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6844
6845 @item mem auto
6846 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6847 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6848
6849 @kindex delete mem
6850 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6851 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6852 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6853
6854 @kindex disable mem
6855 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6856 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6857 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6858 It may be enabled again later.
6859
6860 @kindex enable mem
6861 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6862 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6863
6864 @kindex info mem
6865 @item info mem
6866 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6867 for each region:
6868
6869 @table @emph
6870 @item Memory Region Number
6871 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6872 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6873 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6874
6875 @item Lo Address
6876 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6877
6878 @item Hi Address
6879 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6880
6881 @item Attributes
6882 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6883 @end table
6884 @end table
6885
6886
6887 @subsection Attributes
6888
6889 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6890 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6891 write accesses to a memory region.
6892
6893 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6894 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6895 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6896
6897 @table @code
6898 @item ro
6899 Memory is read only.
6900 @item wo
6901 Memory is write only.
6902 @item rw
6903 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6904 @end table
6905
6906 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6907 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6908 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6909 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6910 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6911
6912 @table @code
6913 @item 8
6914 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6915 @item 16
6916 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6917 @item 32
6918 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6919 @item 64
6920 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6921 @end table
6922
6923 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6924 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6925 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6926 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6927 @c
6928 @c @table @code
6929 @c @item hwbreak
6930 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6931 @c @item swbreak (default)
6932 @c @end table
6933
6934 @subsubsection Data Cache
6935 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6936 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6937 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6938 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6939 registers.
6940
6941 @table @code
6942 @item cache
6943 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6944 @item nocache
6945 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6946 @end table
6947
6948 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6949 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6950 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6951 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6952 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6953
6954 @table @code
6955 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6956 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6957 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6958 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6959 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6960 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6961 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6962 The default value is @code{off}.
6963 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6964 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6965 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6966 @end table
6967
6968
6969 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6970 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6971 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6972 @c
6973 @c @table @code
6974 @c @item verify
6975 @c @item noverify (default)
6976 @c @end table
6977
6978 @node Dump/Restore Files
6979 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
6980 @cindex dump/restore files
6981 @cindex append data to a file
6982 @cindex dump data to a file
6983 @cindex restore data from a file
6984
6985 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6986 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6987 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6988 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6989 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6990 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6991 files.
6992
6993 @table @code
6994
6995 @kindex dump
6996 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6997 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6998 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6999 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7000
7001 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7002 @table @code
7003 @item binary
7004 Raw binary form.
7005 @item ihex
7006 Intel hex format.
7007 @item srec
7008 Motorola S-record format.
7009 @item tekhex
7010 Tektronix Hex format.
7011 @end table
7012
7013 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7014 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7015 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7016 form.
7017
7018 @kindex append
7019 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7020 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7021 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7022 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7023 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7024
7025 @kindex restore
7026 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7027 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7028 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7029 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7030 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7031
7032 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7033 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7034 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7035 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7036 from that location.
7037
7038 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7039 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7040 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7041 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7042
7043 @end table
7044
7045 @node Core File Generation
7046 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7047 @cindex dump core from inferior
7048
7049 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7050 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7051 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7052 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7053 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7054 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7055 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7056
7057 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7058 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7059 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7060
7061 @table @code
7062 @kindex gcore
7063 @kindex generate-core-file
7064 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7065 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7066 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7067 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7068 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7069 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7070
7071 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7072 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7073 @end table
7074
7075 @node Character Sets
7076 @section Character Sets
7077 @cindex character sets
7078 @cindex charset
7079 @cindex translating between character sets
7080 @cindex host character set
7081 @cindex target character set
7082
7083 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7084 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7085 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7086 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7087 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7088 @dfn{target character set}.
7089
7090 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7091 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7092 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7093 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7094 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7095 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7096 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7097 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7098 character and string literals in expressions.
7099
7100 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7101 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7102 target-charset} command, described below.
7103
7104 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7105 support:
7106
7107 @table @code
7108 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7109 @kindex set target-charset
7110 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7111 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7112 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7113 list the target character sets it supports.
7114 @end table
7115
7116 @table @code
7117 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7118 @kindex set host-charset
7119 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7120
7121 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7122 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7123 @code{set host-charset} command.
7124
7125 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7126 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7127 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7128 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7129 list the host character sets it supports.
7130
7131 @item set charset @var{charset}
7132 @kindex set charset
7133 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7134 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7135 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7136 for both host and target.
7137
7138
7139 @item show charset
7140 @kindex show charset
7141 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7142
7143 @itemx show host-charset
7144 @kindex show host-charset
7145 Show the name of the current host charset.
7146
7147 @itemx show target-charset
7148 @kindex show target-charset
7149 Show the name of the current target charset.
7150
7151 @end table
7152
7153 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7154 sets:
7155
7156 @table @code
7157
7158 @item ASCII
7159 @cindex ASCII character set
7160 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7161 character set.
7162
7163 @item ISO-8859-1
7164 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7165 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7166 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7167 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7168 this as its host character set.
7169
7170 @item EBCDIC-US
7171 @itemx IBM1047
7172 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7173 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7174 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7175 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7176 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7177
7178 @end table
7179
7180 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7181 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7182 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7183
7184 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7185 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7186 @file{charset-test.c}:
7187
7188 @smallexample
7189 #include <stdio.h>
7190
7191 char ascii_hello[]
7192 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7193 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7194 char ibm1047_hello[]
7195 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7196 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7197
7198 main ()
7199 @{
7200 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7201 @}
7202 @end smallexample
7203
7204 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7205 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7206 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7207
7208 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7209
7210 @smallexample
7211 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7212 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7213 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7214 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7215 @dots{}
7216 (@value{GDBP})
7217 @end smallexample
7218
7219 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7220 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7221 strings:
7222
7223 @smallexample
7224 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7225 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7226 (@value{GDBP})
7227 @end smallexample
7228
7229 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7230 initial character set:
7231 @smallexample
7232 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7233 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7234 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7235 (@value{GDBP})
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7239 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7240 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7241 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7242 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7243
7244 @smallexample
7245 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7246 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7247 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7248 $2 = 72 'H'
7249 (@value{GDBP})
7250 @end smallexample
7251
7252 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7253 literals you use in expressions:
7254
7255 @smallexample
7256 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7257 $3 = 43 '+'
7258 (@value{GDBP})
7259 @end smallexample
7260
7261 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7262 character.
7263
7264 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7265 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7266 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7267
7268 @smallexample
7269 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7270 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7271 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7272 $5 = 200 '\310'
7273 (@value{GDBP})
7274 @end smallexample
7275
7276 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7277 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7278
7279 @smallexample
7280 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7281 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7282 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7283 @end smallexample
7284
7285 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7286 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7287 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7288 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7289 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7290
7291 @smallexample
7292 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7293 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7294 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7295 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7296 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7297 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7298 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7299 $7 = 72 '\110'
7300 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7301 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7302 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7303 $9 = 200 'H'
7304 (@value{GDBP})
7305 @end smallexample
7306
7307 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7308 string literals you use in expressions:
7309
7310 @smallexample
7311 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7312 $10 = 78 '+'
7313 (@value{GDBP})
7314 @end smallexample
7315
7316 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7317 character.
7318
7319 @node Caching Remote Data
7320 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7321 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7322
7323 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7324 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7325 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7326 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7327 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7328 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7329 volatile registers are in use.
7330
7331 @table @code
7332 @kindex set remotecache
7333 @item set remotecache on
7334 @itemx set remotecache off
7335 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7336 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7337
7338 @kindex show remotecache
7339 @item show remotecache
7340 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7341
7342 @kindex info dcache
7343 @item info dcache
7344 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7345 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7346 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7347 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7348 the data cache operation.
7349 @end table
7350
7351
7352 @node Macros
7353 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7354
7355 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7356 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7357 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7358 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7359 where it was defined.
7360
7361 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7362 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7363 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7364 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7365
7366 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7367 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7368 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7369 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7370 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7371 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7372 see @ref{List}.
7373
7374 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7375 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7376 variable-arity macros.
7377
7378 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7379 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7380 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7381
7382 @table @code
7383
7384 @kindex macro expand
7385 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7386 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7387 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7388 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7389 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7390 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7391 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7392 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7393 it can be any string of tokens.
7394
7395 @kindex macro exp1
7396 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7397 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7398 @cindex expand macro once
7399 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7400 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7401 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7402 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7403 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7404 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7405 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7406 can be any string of tokens.
7407
7408 @kindex info macro
7409 @cindex macro definition, showing
7410 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7411 @item info macro @var{macro}
7412 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7413 source location where that definition was established.
7414
7415 @kindex macro define
7416 @cindex user-defined macros
7417 @cindex defining macros interactively
7418 @cindex macros, user-defined
7419 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7420 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7421 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7422 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7423 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7424 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7425 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7426 given in @var{arglist}.
7427
7428 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7429 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7430 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7431 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7432 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7433
7434 @kindex macro undef
7435 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7436 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7437 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7438 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7439 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7440 debugged.
7441
7442 @kindex macro list
7443 @item macro list
7444 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7445 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7446 @end table
7447
7448 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7449 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7450 show our source files:
7451
7452 @smallexample
7453 $ cat sample.c
7454 #include <stdio.h>
7455 #include "sample.h"
7456
7457 #define M 42
7458 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7459
7460 main ()
7461 @{
7462 #define N 28
7463 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7464 #undef N
7465 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7466 #define N 1729
7467 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7468 @}
7469 $ cat sample.h
7470 #define Q <
7471 $
7472 @end smallexample
7473
7474 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7475 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7476 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7477 information.
7478
7479 @smallexample
7480 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7481 $
7482 @end smallexample
7483
7484 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7485
7486 @smallexample
7487 $ gdb -nw sample
7488 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7489 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7490 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7491 (@value{GDBP})
7492 @end smallexample
7493
7494 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7495 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7496 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7497
7498 @smallexample
7499 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7500 3
7501 4 #define M 42
7502 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7503 6
7504 7 main ()
7505 8 @{
7506 9 #define N 28
7507 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7508 11 #undef N
7509 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7510 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7511 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7512 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7513 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7514 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7515 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7516 #define Q <
7517 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7518 expands to: (42 + 1)
7519 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7520 expands to: once (M + 1)
7521 (@value{GDBP})
7522 @end smallexample
7523
7524 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7525 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7526 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7527 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7528
7529 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7530 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7531
7532 @smallexample
7533 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7534 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7535 (@value{GDBP}) run
7536 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7537
7538 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7539 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7540 (@value{GDBP})
7541 @end smallexample
7542
7543 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7544
7545 @smallexample
7546 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7547 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7548 #define N 28
7549 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7550 expands to: 28 < 42
7551 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7552 $1 = 1
7553 (@value{GDBP})
7554 @end smallexample
7555
7556 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7557 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7558 thereof) in force at each point:
7559
7560 @smallexample
7561 (@value{GDBP}) next
7562 Hello, world!
7563 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7564 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7565 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7566 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7567 (@value{GDBP}) next
7568 We're so creative.
7569 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7570 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7571 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7572 #define N 1729
7573 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7574 expands to: 1729 < 42
7575 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7576 $2 = 0
7577 (@value{GDBP})
7578 @end smallexample
7579
7580
7581 @node Tracepoints
7582 @chapter Tracepoints
7583 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7584 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7585
7586 @cindex tracepoints
7587 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7588 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7589 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7590 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7591 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7592 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7593 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7594
7595 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7596 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7597 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7598 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7599 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7600 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7601 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7602 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7603 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7604 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7605 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7606
7607 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7608 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7609 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7610 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7611 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7612 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7613 Packets}.
7614
7615 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7616
7617 @menu
7618 * Set Tracepoints::
7619 * Analyze Collected Data::
7620 * Tracepoint Variables::
7621 @end menu
7622
7623 @node Set Tracepoints
7624 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7625
7626 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7627 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7628 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7629 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7630 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7631 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7632 work on.
7633
7634 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7635 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7636 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7637 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7638 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7639 tracepoint was hit.
7640
7641 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7642 conditions and actions.
7643
7644 @menu
7645 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7646 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7647 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7648 * Tracepoint Actions::
7649 * Listing Tracepoints::
7650 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7651 @end menu
7652
7653 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7654 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7655
7656 @table @code
7657 @cindex set tracepoint
7658 @kindex trace
7659 @item trace
7660 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7661 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7662 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7663 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7664 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7665 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7666 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7667 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7668 running.
7669
7670 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7671
7672 @smallexample
7673 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7674
7675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7676
7677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7678
7679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7680
7681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7682 @end smallexample
7683
7684 @noindent
7685 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7686
7687 @vindex $tpnum
7688 @cindex last tracepoint number
7689 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7690 @cindex tracepoint number
7691 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7692 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7693
7694 @kindex delete tracepoint
7695 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7696 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7697 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7698 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7699
7700 Examples:
7701
7702 @smallexample
7703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7704
7705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7706 @end smallexample
7707
7708 @noindent
7709 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7710 @end table
7711
7712 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7713 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7714
7715 @table @code
7716 @kindex disable tracepoint
7717 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7718 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7719 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7720 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7721 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7722
7723 @kindex enable tracepoint
7724 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7725 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7726 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7727 run.
7728 @end table
7729
7730 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7731 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7732
7733 @table @code
7734 @kindex passcount
7735 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7736 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7737 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7738 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7739 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7740 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7741 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7742 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7743 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7744 user.
7745
7746 Examples:
7747
7748 @smallexample
7749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7750 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7751
7752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7753 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7760 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7761 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7762 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7763 @end smallexample
7764 @end table
7765
7766 @node Tracepoint Actions
7767 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7768
7769 @table @code
7770 @kindex actions
7771 @cindex tracepoint actions
7772 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7773 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7774 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7775 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7776 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7777 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7778 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7779 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7780 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7781 @code{while-stepping}.
7782
7783 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7784 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7785 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7786
7787 @smallexample
7788 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7789
7790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7791
7792 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7793 @end smallexample
7794
7795 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7796 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7797 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7798 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7799 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7800 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7801 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7802 @code{end} command.
7803
7804 @smallexample
7805 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7806 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7807 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7808 > collect bar,baz
7809 > collect $regs
7810 > while-stepping 12
7811 > collect $fp, $sp
7812 > end
7813 end
7814 @end smallexample
7815
7816 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7817 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7818 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7819 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7820 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7821 special arguments are supported:
7822
7823 @table @code
7824 @item $regs
7825 collect all registers
7826
7827 @item $args
7828 collect all function arguments
7829
7830 @item $locals
7831 collect all local variables.
7832 @end table
7833
7834 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7835 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7836 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7837
7838 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7839 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7840
7841 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7842 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7843 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7844 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7845 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7846 its own @code{end} command):
7847
7848 @smallexample
7849 > while-stepping 12
7850 > collect $regs, myglobal
7851 > end
7852 >
7853 @end smallexample
7854
7855 @noindent
7856 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7857 @code{stepping}.
7858 @end table
7859
7860 @node Listing Tracepoints
7861 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7862
7863 @table @code
7864 @kindex info tracepoints
7865 @kindex info tp
7866 @cindex information about tracepoints
7867 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7868 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7869 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7870 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7871 shown:
7872
7873 @itemize @bullet
7874 @item
7875 its number
7876 @item
7877 whether it is enabled or disabled
7878 @item
7879 its address
7880 @item
7881 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7882 @item
7883 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7884 @item
7885 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7886 @item
7887 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7888 @end itemize
7889
7890 @smallexample
7891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7892 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7893 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7894 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7895 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7896 (@value{GDBP})
7897 @end smallexample
7898
7899 @noindent
7900 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7901 @end table
7902
7903 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7904 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7905
7906 @table @code
7907 @kindex tstart
7908 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7909 @cindex collected data discarded
7910 @item tstart
7911 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7912 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7913 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7914 experiment.
7915
7916 @kindex tstop
7917 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7918 @item tstop
7919 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7920 stops collecting data.
7921
7922 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7923 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7924 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7925
7926 @kindex tstatus
7927 @cindex status of trace data collection
7928 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7929 @item tstatus
7930 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7931 collection.
7932 @end table
7933
7934 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7935
7936 @smallexample
7937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7938 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7939 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7940 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7941 > while-stepping 11
7942 > collect $regs
7943 > end
7944 > end
7945 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7946 [time passes @dots{}]
7947 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7948 @end smallexample
7949
7950
7951 @node Analyze Collected Data
7952 @section Using the Collected Data
7953
7954 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7955 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7956 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7957 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7958 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7959 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7960 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7961 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7962 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7963 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7964 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7965 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7966 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7967 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7968 the buffer will fail.
7969
7970 @menu
7971 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7972 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7973 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7974 @end menu
7975
7976 @node tfind
7977 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7978
7979 @kindex tfind
7980 @cindex select trace snapshot
7981 @cindex find trace snapshot
7982 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7983 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7984 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7985 snapshot is selected.
7986
7987 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7988
7989 @table @code
7990 @item tfind start
7991 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7992 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7993
7994 @item tfind none
7995 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7996
7997 @item tfind end
7998 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7999
8000 @item tfind
8001 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8002
8003 @item tfind -
8004 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8005 retracing earlier steps.
8006
8007 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8008 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8009 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8010 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8011 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8012
8013 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8014 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8015 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8016 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8017 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8018
8019 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8020 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8021 addresses.
8022
8023 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8024 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8025 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8026
8027 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8028 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8029 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8030 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8031 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8032 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8033 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8034 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8035 @end table
8036
8037 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8038 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8039 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8040 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8041 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8042 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8043 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8044 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8045 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8046 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8047 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8048 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8049 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8050 tracepoint as the current one.
8051
8052 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8053 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8054 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8055 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8056 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8057
8058 @smallexample
8059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8060 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8061 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8062 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8063 > tfind
8064 > end
8065
8066 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8067 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8068 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8069 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8070 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8071 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8072 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8073 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8074 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8075 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8076 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8077 @end smallexample
8078
8079 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8080 the buffer:
8081
8082 @smallexample
8083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8084 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8085 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8086 > tfind line
8087 > end
8088
8089 Frame 0, X = 1
8090 Frame 7, X = 2
8091 Frame 13, X = 255
8092 @end smallexample
8093
8094 @node tdump
8095 @subsection @code{tdump}
8096 @kindex tdump
8097 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8098 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8099
8100 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8101 the current trace snapshot.
8102
8103 @smallexample
8104 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8105 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8106 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8107 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8108 > end
8109
8110 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8111
8112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8113 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8114 at gdb_test.c:444
8115 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8116
8117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8118 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8119 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8120 d1 0x18 24
8121 d2 0x80 128
8122 d3 0x33 51
8123 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8124 d5 0x22 34
8125 d6 0xe0 224
8126 d7 0x380035 3670069
8127 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8128 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8129 a2 0x100 256
8130 a3 0x322000 3284992
8131 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8132 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8133 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8134 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8135 ps 0x0 0
8136 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8137 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8138 fpstatus 0x0 0
8139 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8140 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8141 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8142 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8143 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8144 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8145 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8146 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8147 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8148
8149 (@value{GDBP})
8150 @end smallexample
8151
8152 @node save-tracepoints
8153 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8154 @kindex save-tracepoints
8155 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8156
8157 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8158 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8159 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8160 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8161 Files}).
8162
8163 @node Tracepoint Variables
8164 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8165 @cindex tracepoint variables
8166 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8167
8168 @table @code
8169 @vindex $trace_frame
8170 @item (int) $trace_frame
8171 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8172 snapshot is selected.
8173
8174 @vindex $tracepoint
8175 @item (int) $tracepoint
8176 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8177
8178 @vindex $trace_line
8179 @item (int) $trace_line
8180 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8181
8182 @vindex $trace_file
8183 @item (char []) $trace_file
8184 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8185
8186 @vindex $trace_func
8187 @item (char []) $trace_func
8188 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8189 @end table
8190
8191 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8192 use @code{output} instead.
8193
8194 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8195 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8196 data.
8197
8198 @smallexample
8199 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8200
8201 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8202 > output $trace_file
8203 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8204 > tfind
8205 > end
8206 @end smallexample
8207
8208 @node Overlays
8209 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8210 @cindex overlays
8211
8212 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8213 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8214 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8215 use overlays.
8216
8217 @menu
8218 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8219 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8220 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8221 mapped by asking the inferior.
8222 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8223 @end menu
8224
8225 @node How Overlays Work
8226 @section How Overlays Work
8227 @cindex mapped overlays
8228 @cindex unmapped overlays
8229 @cindex load address, overlay's
8230 @cindex mapped address
8231 @cindex overlay area
8232
8233 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8234 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8235 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8236 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8237 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8238
8239 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8240 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8241 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8242 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8243 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8244 largest overlay as well.
8245
8246 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8247 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8248 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8249 there.
8250
8251 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8252 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8253 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8254
8255 @smallexample
8256 @group
8257 Data Instruction Larger
8258 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8259 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8260 | | | | | |
8261 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8262 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8263 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8264 | and heap | | | | | |
8265 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8266 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8267 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8268 | | | | | |
8269 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8270 address | | | | | |
8271 | overlay | <-' | | |
8272 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8273 | | <---. | | load address
8274 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8275 | | | |
8276 +-----------+ | |
8277 +-----------+
8278 | |
8279 +-----------+
8280
8281 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8282 @end group
8283 @end smallexample
8284
8285 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8286 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8287 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8288 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8289 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8290 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8291 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8292 program and the overlay area.
8293
8294 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8295 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8296 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8297 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8298 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8299 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8300 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8301
8302 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8303 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8304 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8305
8306 @itemize @bullet
8307
8308 @item
8309 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8310 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8311 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8312 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8313
8314 @item
8315 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8316 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8317 your program's performance.
8318
8319 @item
8320 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8321 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8322 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8323 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8324 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8325 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8326 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8327
8328 @item
8329 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8330 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8331 instruction and data spaces.
8332
8333 @end itemize
8334
8335 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8336 improved in many ways:
8337
8338 @itemize @bullet
8339
8340 @item
8341 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8342 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8343 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8344 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8345 area in the usual way.
8346
8347 @item
8348 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8349 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8350
8351 @item
8352 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8353 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8354 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8355 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8356 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8357 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8358 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8359
8360 @end itemize
8361
8362
8363 @node Overlay Commands
8364 @section Overlay Commands
8365
8366 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8367 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8368 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8369 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8370 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8371 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8372
8373 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8374 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8375
8376 @table @code
8377 @item overlay off
8378 @kindex overlay
8379 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8380 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8381 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8382 overlay support is disabled.
8383
8384 @item overlay manual
8385 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8386 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8387 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8388 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8389 commands described below.
8390
8391 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8392 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8393 @cindex map an overlay
8394 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8395 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8396 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8397 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8398 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8399 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8400
8401 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8402 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8403 @cindex unmap an overlay
8404 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8405 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8406 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8407 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8408
8409 @item overlay auto
8410 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8411 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8412 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8413 Overlay Debugging}.
8414
8415 @item overlay load-target
8416 @itemx overlay load
8417 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8418 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8419 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8420 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8421 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8422 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8423
8424 @item overlay list-overlays
8425 @itemx overlay list
8426 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8427 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8428 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8429
8430 @end table
8431
8432 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8433 of the function the address falls in:
8434
8435 @smallexample
8436 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8437 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8438 @end smallexample
8439 @noindent
8440 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8441 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8442 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8443 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8444
8445 @smallexample
8446 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8447 No sections are mapped.
8448 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8449 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8450 @end smallexample
8451 @noindent
8452 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8453 name normally:
8454
8455 @smallexample
8456 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8457 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8458 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8459 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8460 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8461 @end smallexample
8462
8463 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8464 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8465 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8466 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8467 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8468
8469 @itemize @bullet
8470 @item
8471 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8472 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8473 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8474 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8475 @item
8476 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8477 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8478 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8479 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8480 breakpoints properly.
8481 @end itemize
8482
8483
8484 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8485 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8486 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8487
8488 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8489 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8490 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8491 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8492 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8493 current state of the overlays.
8494
8495 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8496 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8497
8498 @table @asis
8499
8500 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8501 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8502
8503 @smallexample
8504 struct
8505 @{
8506 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8507 unsigned long vma;
8508
8509 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8510 unsigned long size;
8511
8512 /* The overlay's load address. */
8513 unsigned long lma;
8514
8515 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8516 zero otherwise. */
8517 unsigned long mapped;
8518 @}
8519 @end smallexample
8520
8521 @item @code{_novlys}:
8522 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8523 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8524
8525 @end table
8526
8527 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8528 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8529 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8530 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8531 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8532 currently mapped.
8533
8534 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8535 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8536 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8537 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8538 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8539 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8540 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8541 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8542 are not being executed.
8543
8544 @node Overlay Sample Program
8545 @section Overlay Sample Program
8546 @cindex overlay example program
8547
8548 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8549 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8550 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8551 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8552 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8553 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8554 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8555
8556 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8557 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8558 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8559 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8560
8561 @table @file
8562 @item overlays.c
8563 The main program file.
8564 @item ovlymgr.c
8565 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8566 @item foo.c
8567 @itemx bar.c
8568 @itemx baz.c
8569 @itemx grbx.c
8570 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8571 @item d10v.ld
8572 @itemx m32r.ld
8573 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8574 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8575 @end table
8576
8577 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8578 cross-compiler like this:
8579
8580 @smallexample
8581 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8582 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8583 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8584 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8585 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8586 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8587 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8588 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8589 @end smallexample
8590
8591 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8592 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8593 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8594
8595
8596 @node Languages
8597 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8598 @cindex languages
8599
8600 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8601 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8602 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8603 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8604 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8605 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8606
8607 @cindex working language
8608 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8609 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8610 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8611 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8612 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8613 language}.
8614
8615 @menu
8616 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8617 * Show:: Displaying the language
8618 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8619 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8620 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8621 @end menu
8622
8623 @node Setting
8624 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8625
8626 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8627 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8628 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8629 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8630 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8631 are printed, etc.
8632
8633 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8634 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8635 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8636 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8637 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8638 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8639 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8640 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8641 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8642 Displaying the Language}.
8643
8644 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8645 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8646 another language. In that case, make the
8647 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8648 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8649 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8650
8651 @menu
8652 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8653 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8654 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8655 @end menu
8656
8657 @node Filenames
8658 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8659
8660 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8661 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8662
8663 @table @file
8664 @item .ada
8665 @itemx .ads
8666 @itemx .adb
8667 @itemx .a
8668 Ada source file.
8669
8670 @item .c
8671 C source file
8672
8673 @item .C
8674 @itemx .cc
8675 @itemx .cp
8676 @itemx .cpp
8677 @itemx .cxx
8678 @itemx .c++
8679 C@t{++} source file
8680
8681 @item .m
8682 Objective-C source file
8683
8684 @item .f
8685 @itemx .F
8686 Fortran source file
8687
8688 @item .mod
8689 Modula-2 source file
8690
8691 @item .s
8692 @itemx .S
8693 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8694 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8695 @end table
8696
8697 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8698 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8699
8700 @node Manually
8701 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8702
8703 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8704 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8705 your program.
8706
8707 @kindex set language
8708 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8709 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8710 a language, such as
8711 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8712 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8713
8714 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8715 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8716 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8717 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8718 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8719 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8720 command such as:
8721
8722 @smallexample
8723 print a = b + c
8724 @end smallexample
8725
8726 @noindent
8727 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8728 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8729 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8730 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8731
8732 @node Automatically
8733 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8734
8735 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8736 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8737 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8738 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8739 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8740 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8741 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8742 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8743 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8744
8745 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8746 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8747 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8748 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8749 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8750
8751 @node Show
8752 @section Displaying the Language
8753
8754 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8755 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8756
8757 @table @code
8758 @item show language
8759 @kindex show language
8760 Display the current working language. This is the
8761 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8762 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8763
8764 @item info frame
8765 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8766 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8767 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8768 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8769 information listed here.
8770
8771 @item info source
8772 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8773 Display the source language of this source file.
8774 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8775 information listed here.
8776 @end table
8777
8778 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8779 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8780 with a language explicitly:
8781
8782 @table @code
8783 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8784 @kindex set extension-language
8785 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8786 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8787
8788 @item info extensions
8789 @kindex info extensions
8790 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8791 @end table
8792
8793 @node Checks
8794 @section Type and Range Checking
8795
8796 @quotation
8797 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8798 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8799 section documents the intended facilities.
8800 @end quotation
8801 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8802
8803 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8804 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8805 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8806 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8807 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8808 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8809 errors when your program is running.
8810
8811 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8812 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8813 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8814 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8815 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8816 automatically based on your program's source language.
8817 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8818 settings of supported languages.
8819
8820 @menu
8821 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8822 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8823 @end menu
8824
8825 @cindex type checking
8826 @cindex checks, type
8827 @node Type Checking
8828 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8829
8830 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8831 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8832 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8833 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8834
8835 @smallexample
8836 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8837 @exdent but
8838 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8839 @end smallexample
8840
8841 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8842 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8843
8844 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8845 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8846 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8847 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8848 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8849 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8850 also issues a warning.
8851
8852 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8853 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8854 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8855 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8856 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8857 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8858
8859 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8860 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8861 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8862 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8863 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8864 details on specific languages.
8865
8866 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8867
8868 @kindex set check type
8869 @kindex show check type
8870 @table @code
8871 @item set check type auto
8872 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8873 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8874 each language.
8875
8876 @item set check type on
8877 @itemx set check type off
8878 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8879 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8880 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8881 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8882 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8883
8884 @item set check type warn
8885 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8886 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8887 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8888 numbers and structures.
8889
8890 @item show type
8891 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8892 is setting it automatically.
8893 @end table
8894
8895 @cindex range checking
8896 @cindex checks, range
8897 @node Range Checking
8898 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
8899
8900 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8901 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8902 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8903 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8904 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8905
8906 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8907 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8908 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8909 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8910
8911 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8912 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8913 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8914 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8915 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8916 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8917
8918 @smallexample
8919 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8920 @end smallexample
8921
8922 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8923 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
8924 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8925
8926 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8927
8928 @kindex set check range
8929 @kindex show check range
8930 @table @code
8931 @item set check range auto
8932 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8933 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8934 each language.
8935
8936 @item set check range on
8937 @itemx set check range off
8938 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8939 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8940 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8941 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8942
8943 @item set check range warn
8944 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8945 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8946 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8947 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8948 systems).
8949
8950 @item show range
8951 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8952 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8953 @end table
8954
8955 @node Supported Languages
8956 @section Supported Languages
8957
8958 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8959 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8960 @c This is false ...
8961 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8962 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8963 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8964 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8965 language.
8966
8967 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8968 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8969 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8970 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8971 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8972 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8973 language reference or tutorial.
8974
8975 @menu
8976 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8977 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8978 * Fortran:: Fortran
8979 * Pascal:: Pascal
8980 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8981 * Ada:: Ada
8982 @end menu
8983
8984 @node C
8985 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8986
8987 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8988 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8989
8990 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8991 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8992 together.
8993
8994 @cindex C@t{++}
8995 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8996 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8997 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8998 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8999 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9000 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9001 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9002
9003 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9004 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9005 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9006 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9007 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9008 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9009
9010 @menu
9011 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9012 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9013 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9014 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9015 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9016 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9017 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9018 @end menu
9019
9020 @node C Operators
9021 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9022
9023 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9024
9025 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9026 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9027 often defined on groups of types.
9028
9029 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9030
9031 @itemize @bullet
9032
9033 @item
9034 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9035 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9036
9037 @item
9038 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9039 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9040
9041 @item
9042 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9043
9044 @item
9045 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9046
9047 @end itemize
9048
9049 @noindent
9050 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9051 in order of increasing precedence:
9052
9053 @table @code
9054 @item ,
9055 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9056 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9057 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9058
9059 @item =
9060 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9061 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9062
9063 @item @var{op}=
9064 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9065 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9066 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9067 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9068 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9069
9070 @item ?:
9071 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9072 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9073 integral type.
9074
9075 @item ||
9076 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9077
9078 @item &&
9079 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9080
9081 @item |
9082 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9083
9084 @item ^
9085 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9086
9087 @item &
9088 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9089
9090 @item ==@r{, }!=
9091 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9092 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9093
9094 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9095 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9096 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9097 and non-zero for true.
9098
9099 @item <<@r{, }>>
9100 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9101
9102 @item @@
9103 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9104
9105 @item +@r{, }-
9106 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9107 pointer types.
9108
9109 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9110 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9111 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9112 integral types.
9113
9114 @item ++@r{, }--
9115 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9116 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9117 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9118 operation takes place.
9119
9120 @item *
9121 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9122 @code{++}.
9123
9124 @item &
9125 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9126
9127 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9128 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9129 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9130 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9131 stored.
9132
9133 @item -
9134 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9135 precedence as @code{++}.
9136
9137 @item !
9138 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9139 @code{++}.
9140
9141 @item ~
9142 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9143 @code{++}.
9144
9145
9146 @item .@r{, }->
9147 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9148 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9149 pointer based on the stored type information.
9150 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9151
9152 @item .*@r{, }->*
9153 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9154
9155 @item []
9156 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9157 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9158
9159 @item ()
9160 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9161
9162 @item ::
9163 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9164 and @code{class} types.
9165
9166 @item ::
9167 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9168 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9169 above.
9170 @end table
9171
9172 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9173 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9174 predefined meaning.
9175
9176 @node C Constants
9177 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9178
9179 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9180
9181 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9182 following ways:
9183
9184 @itemize @bullet
9185 @item
9186 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9187 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9188 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9189 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9190 @code{long} value.
9191
9192 @item
9193 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9194 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9195 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9196 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9197 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9198 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9199 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9200 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9201 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9202 constant.
9203
9204 @item
9205 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9206 integral equivalents.
9207
9208 @item
9209 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9210 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9211 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9212 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9213 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9214 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9215 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9216 @samp{\n} for newline.
9217
9218 @item
9219 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9220 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9221 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9222 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9223 characters.
9224
9225 @item
9226 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9227 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9228
9229 @item
9230 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9231 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9232 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9233 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9234 @end itemize
9235
9236 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9237 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9238
9239 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9240 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9241
9242 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9243 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9244 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9245 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9246 @quotation
9247 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9248 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9249 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9250 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9251 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9252 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9253 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9254 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9255 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9256 C@t{++} code.
9257 @end quotation
9258
9259 @enumerate
9260
9261 @cindex member functions
9262 @item
9263 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9264
9265 @smallexample
9266 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9267 @end smallexample
9268
9269 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9270 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9271 @item
9272 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9273 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9274 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9275 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9276
9277 @cindex call overloaded functions
9278 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9279 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9280 @item
9281 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9282 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9283 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9284 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9285 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9286 default arguments.
9287
9288 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9289 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9290 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9291 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9292 number of function arguments.
9293
9294 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9295 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9296 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9297
9298 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9299 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9300 @smallexample
9301 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9302 @end smallexample
9303
9304 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9305 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9306
9307 @cindex reference declarations
9308 @item
9309 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9310 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9311 dereferenced.
9312
9313 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9314 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9315 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9316 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9317 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9318
9319 @item
9320 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9321 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9322 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9323 necessary, for example in an expression like
9324 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9325 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9326 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9327 @end enumerate
9328
9329 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9330 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9331 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9332 invoking user-defined operators.
9333
9334 @node C Defaults
9335 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9336
9337 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9338
9339 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9340 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9341 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9342 selects the working language.
9343
9344 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9345 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9346 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9347 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9348 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9349 for further details.
9350
9351 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9352 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9353 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9354
9355 @node C Checks
9356 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9357
9358 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9359
9360 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9361 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9362 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9363
9364 @itemize @bullet
9365 @item
9366 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9367 enumerated tag.
9368
9369 @item
9370 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9371 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9372
9373 @ignore
9374 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9375 @c FIXME--beers?
9376 @item
9377 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9378 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9379 compilers.)
9380 @end ignore
9381 @end itemize
9382
9383 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9384 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9385 that is not itself an array.
9386
9387 @node Debugging C
9388 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9389
9390 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9391 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9392 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9393 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9394
9395 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9396 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9397 ,Expressions}.
9398
9399 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9400 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9401
9402 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9403
9404 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9405 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9406
9407 @table @code
9408 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9409 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9410 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9411 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9412 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9413
9414 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9415 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9416 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9417 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9418 classes.
9419 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9420
9421 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9422 @item catch throw
9423 @itemx catch catch
9424 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9425 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9426
9427 @cindex inheritance
9428 @item ptype @var{typename}
9429 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9430 @var{typename}.
9431 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9432
9433 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9434 @item set print demangle
9435 @itemx show print demangle
9436 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9437 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9438 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9439 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9440 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9441
9442 @item set print object
9443 @itemx show print object
9444 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9445 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9446
9447 @item set print vtbl
9448 @itemx show print vtbl
9449 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9450 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9451 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9452 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9453
9454 @kindex set overload-resolution
9455 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9456 @item set overload-resolution on
9457 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9458 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9459 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9460 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9461 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9462 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9463
9464 @item set overload-resolution off
9465 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9466 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9467 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9468 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9469 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9470 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9471 argument types.
9472
9473 @kindex show overload-resolution
9474 @item show overload-resolution
9475 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9476
9477 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9478 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9479 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9480 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9481 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9482 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9483 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9484 @end table
9485
9486 @node Objective-C
9487 @subsection Objective-C
9488
9489 @cindex Objective-C
9490 This section provides information about some commands and command
9491 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9492 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9493 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9494
9495 @menu
9496 * Method Names in Commands::
9497 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9498 @end menu
9499
9500 @node Method Names in Commands
9501 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9502
9503 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9504 names as line specifications:
9505
9506 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9507 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9508 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9509 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9510 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9511 @itemize
9512 @item @code{clear}
9513 @item @code{break}
9514 @item @code{info line}
9515 @item @code{jump}
9516 @item @code{list}
9517 @end itemize
9518
9519 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9520
9521 @smallexample
9522 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9523 @end smallexample
9524
9525 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9526 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9527 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9528 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9529 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9530 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9531 debugged, enter:
9532
9533 @smallexample
9534 break -[Fruit create]
9535 @end smallexample
9536
9537 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9538 enter:
9539
9540 @smallexample
9541 list +[NSText initialize]
9542 @end smallexample
9543
9544 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9545 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9546 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9547 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9548
9549 @smallexample
9550 break create
9551 @end smallexample
9552
9553 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9554 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9555 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9556 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9557 none apply.
9558
9559 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9560 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9561
9562 @smallexample
9563 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9564 @end smallexample
9565
9566 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9567 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9568 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9569 @kindex print-object
9570 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9571
9572 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9573
9574 @smallexample
9575 print -[@var{object} hash]
9576 @end smallexample
9577
9578 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9579 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9580 @noindent
9581 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9582 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9583 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9584 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9585 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9586 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9587
9588 @node Fortran
9589 @subsection Fortran
9590 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9591
9592 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9593 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9594
9595 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9596 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9597 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9598 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9599 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9600 underscore.
9601
9602 @menu
9603 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9604 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9605 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9606 @end menu
9607
9608 @node Fortran Operators
9609 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9610
9611 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9612
9613 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9614 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9615 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9616
9617 @table @code
9618 @item **
9619 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9620 of the second one.
9621
9622 @item :
9623 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9624 represent a section of array.
9625 @end table
9626
9627 @node Fortran Defaults
9628 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9629
9630 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9631
9632 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9633 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9634 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9635 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9636
9637 @node Special Fortran Commands
9638 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9639
9640 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9641
9642 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9643 such as displaying common blocks.
9644
9645 @table @code
9646 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9647 @kindex info common
9648 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9649 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9650 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9651 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9652 printed.
9653 @end table
9654
9655 @node Pascal
9656 @subsection Pascal
9657
9658 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9659 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9660 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9661 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9662 syntax.
9663
9664 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9665 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9666 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9667
9668 @node Modula-2
9669 @subsection Modula-2
9670
9671 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9672
9673 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9674 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9675 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9676 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9677 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9678 table.
9679
9680 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9681 @menu
9682 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9683 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9684 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9685 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9686 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9687 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9688 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9689 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9690 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9691 @end menu
9692
9693 @node M2 Operators
9694 @subsubsection Operators
9695 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9696
9697 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9698 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9699 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9700 following definitions hold:
9701
9702 @itemize @bullet
9703
9704 @item
9705 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9706 their subranges.
9707
9708 @item
9709 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9710
9711 @item
9712 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9713
9714 @item
9715 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9716 @var{type}}.
9717
9718 @item
9719 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9720
9721 @item
9722 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9723
9724 @item
9725 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9726 @end itemize
9727
9728 @noindent
9729 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9730 increasing precedence:
9731
9732 @table @code
9733 @item ,
9734 Function argument or array index separator.
9735
9736 @item :=
9737 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9738 @var{value}.
9739
9740 @item <@r{, }>
9741 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9742 types.
9743
9744 @item <=@r{, }>=
9745 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9746 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9747 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9748
9749 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9750 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9751 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9752 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9753 comment character.
9754
9755 @item IN
9756 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9757 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9758
9759 @item OR
9760 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9761
9762 @item AND@r{, }&
9763 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9764
9765 @item @@
9766 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9767
9768 @item +@r{, }-
9769 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9770 and difference on set types.
9771
9772 @item *
9773 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9774 on set types.
9775
9776 @item /
9777 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9778 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9779
9780 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9781 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9782 precedence as @code{*}.
9783
9784 @item -
9785 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9786
9787 @item ^
9788 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9789
9790 @item NOT
9791 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9792 @code{^}.
9793
9794 @item .
9795 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9796 precedence as @code{^}.
9797
9798 @item []
9799 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9800
9801 @item ()
9802 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9803 as @code{^}.
9804
9805 @item ::@r{, }.
9806 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9807 @end table
9808
9809 @quotation
9810 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9811 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9812 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9813 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9814 @end quotation
9815
9816
9817 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9818 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9819 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9820
9821 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9822 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9823
9824 @table @var
9825
9826 @item a
9827 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9828
9829 @item c
9830 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9831
9832 @item i
9833 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9834
9835 @item m
9836 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9837 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9838 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9839
9840 @item n
9841 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9842
9843 @item r
9844 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9845
9846 @item t
9847 represents a type.
9848
9849 @item v
9850 represents a variable.
9851
9852 @item x
9853 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9854 explanation of the function for details.
9855 @end table
9856
9857 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9858
9859 @table @code
9860 @item ABS(@var{n})
9861 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9862
9863 @item CAP(@var{c})
9864 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9865 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9866
9867 @item CHR(@var{i})
9868 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9869
9870 @item DEC(@var{v})
9871 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9872
9873 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9874 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9875 new value.
9876
9877 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9878 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9879 set.
9880
9881 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9882 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9883
9884 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9885 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9886
9887 @item INC(@var{v})
9888 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9889
9890 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9891 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9892 new value.
9893
9894 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9895 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9896 there. Returns the new set.
9897
9898 @item MAX(@var{t})
9899 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9900
9901 @item MIN(@var{t})
9902 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9903
9904 @item ODD(@var{i})
9905 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9906
9907 @item ORD(@var{x})
9908 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9909 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9910 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9911 integral, character and enumerated types.
9912
9913 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9914 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9915
9916 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9917 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9918
9919 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9920 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9921 @end table
9922
9923 @quotation
9924 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9925 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9926 an error.
9927 @end quotation
9928
9929 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9930 @node M2 Constants
9931 @subsubsection Constants
9932
9933 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9934 ways:
9935
9936 @itemize @bullet
9937
9938 @item
9939 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9940 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9941 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9942 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9943
9944 @item
9945 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9946 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9947 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9948 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9949 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9950 digits.
9951
9952 @item
9953 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9954 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9955 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9956 followed by a @samp{C}.
9957
9958 @item
9959 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9960 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9961 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9962 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9963 sequences.
9964
9965 @item
9966 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9967
9968 @item
9969 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9970 @code{FALSE}.
9971
9972 @item
9973 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9974
9975 @item
9976 Set constants are not yet supported.
9977 @end itemize
9978
9979 @node M2 Types
9980 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9981 @cindex Modula-2 types
9982
9983 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9984 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9985 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9986 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9987 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9988 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9989
9990 The first example contains the following section of code:
9991
9992 @smallexample
9993 VAR
9994 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9995 r: [20..40] ;
9996 @end smallexample
9997
9998 @noindent
9999 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10000 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10001
10002 @smallexample
10003 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10004 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10005 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10006 SET OF CHAR
10007 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10008 21
10009 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10010 [20..40]
10011 @end smallexample
10012
10013 @noindent
10014 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10015
10016 @smallexample
10017 VAR
10018 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10019 @end smallexample
10020
10021 @noindent
10022 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10023
10024 @smallexample
10025 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10026 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10027 @end smallexample
10028
10029 @noindent
10030 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10031 expressions using the debugger.
10032
10033 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10034 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10035
10036 @smallexample
10037 VAR
10038 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10039 @end smallexample
10040
10041 @smallexample
10042 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10043 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10044 @end smallexample
10045
10046 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10047 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10048 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10049 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10050
10051 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10052
10053 @smallexample
10054 TYPE
10055 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10056 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10057 VAR
10058 s: t ;
10059 BEGIN
10060 s := blue ;
10061 @end smallexample
10062
10063 @noindent
10064 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10065 and value of a variable.
10066
10067 @smallexample
10068 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10069 $1 = blue
10070 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10071 type = [blue..yellow]
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @noindent
10075 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10076 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10077 their @code{C} counterparts.
10078
10079 @smallexample
10080 VAR
10081 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10082 BEGIN
10083 s[1] := 1 ;
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @smallexample
10087 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10088 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10089 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10090 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10094 pointer types as shown in this example:
10095
10096 @smallexample
10097 VAR
10098 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10099 BEGIN
10100 NEW(s) ;
10101 s^[1] := 1 ;
10102 @end smallexample
10103
10104 @noindent
10105 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10106
10107 @smallexample
10108 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10109 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10110 @end smallexample
10111
10112 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10113 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10114 types:
10115
10116 @smallexample
10117 TYPE
10118 foo = RECORD
10119 f1: CARDINAL ;
10120 f2: CHAR ;
10121 f3: myarray ;
10122 END ;
10123
10124 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10125 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10126 VAR
10127 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10128 @end smallexample
10129
10130 @noindent
10131 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10132 below.
10133
10134 @smallexample
10135 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10136 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10137 f1 : CARDINAL;
10138 f2 : CHAR;
10139 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10140 END
10141 @end smallexample
10142
10143 @node M2 Defaults
10144 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10145 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10146
10147 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10148 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10149 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10150 selected the working language.
10151
10152 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10153 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10154 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10155 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10156
10157 @node Deviations
10158 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10159 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10160
10161 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10162 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10163
10164 @itemize @bullet
10165 @item
10166 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10167 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10168 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10169 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10170 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10171 returned a pointer.)
10172
10173 @item
10174 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10175 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10176 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10177 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10178
10179 @item
10180 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10181 argument.
10182
10183 @item
10184 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10185 @end itemize
10186
10187 @node M2 Checks
10188 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10189 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10190
10191 @quotation
10192 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10193 range checking.
10194 @end quotation
10195 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10196
10197 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10198
10199 @itemize @bullet
10200 @item
10201 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10202 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10203
10204 @item
10205 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10206 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10207 @end itemize
10208
10209 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10210 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10211
10212 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10213 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10214
10215 @node M2 Scope
10216 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10217 @cindex scope
10218 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10219 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10220 @ifinfo
10221 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10222 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10223 @end ifinfo
10224 @iftex
10225 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10226 @end iftex
10227
10228 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10229 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10230 similar syntax:
10231
10232 @smallexample
10233
10234 @var{module} . @var{id}
10235 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10236 @end smallexample
10237
10238 @noindent
10239 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10240 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10241 identifier within your program, except another module.
10242
10243 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10244 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10245 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10246 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10247
10248 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10249 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10250 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10251 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10252 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10253 @var{module}.
10254
10255 @node GDB/M2
10256 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10257
10258 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10259 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10260 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10261 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10262 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10263 analogue in Modula-2.
10264
10265 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10266 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10267 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10268 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10269 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10270 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10271
10272 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10273 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10274 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10275
10276 @node Ada
10277 @subsection Ada
10278 @cindex Ada
10279
10280 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10281 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10282 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10283 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10284 to be difficult.
10285
10286
10287 @cindex expressions in Ada
10288 @menu
10289 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10290 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10291 in @value{GDBN}.
10292 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10293 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10294 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10295 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10296 @end menu
10297
10298 @node Ada Mode Intro
10299 @subsubsection Introduction
10300 @cindex Ada mode, general
10301
10302 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10303 syntax, with some extensions.
10304 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10305
10306 @itemize @bullet
10307 @item
10308 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10309 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10310 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10311 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10312
10313 @item
10314 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10315 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10316
10317 @item
10318 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10319 @end itemize
10320
10321 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10322 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10323 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10324 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10325 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10326
10327 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10328 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10329 was translated from an Ada source file.
10330
10331 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10332 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10333 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10334 middle (to allow based literals).
10335
10336 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10337 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10338 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10339 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10340 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10341 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10342
10343 @node Omissions from Ada
10344 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10345 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10346
10347 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10348
10349 @itemize @bullet
10350 @item
10351 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10352
10353 @itemize @minus
10354 @item
10355 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10356 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10357
10358 @item
10359 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10360
10361 @item
10362 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10363
10364 @item
10365 @t{'Tag}.
10366
10367 @item
10368 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10369 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10370
10371 @item
10372 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10373 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10374
10375 @item
10376 @t{'Address}.
10377 @end itemize
10378
10379 @item
10380 The names in
10381 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10382 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10383 not currently available.
10384
10385 @item
10386 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10387 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10388 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10389 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10390 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10391 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10392 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10393 indeterminate values.
10394
10395 @item
10396 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10397 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10398 are not implemented.
10399
10400 @item
10401 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10402 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10403 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10404 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10405 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10406
10407 @smallexample
10408 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10409 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10410 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10411 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10412 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10413 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10414 @end smallexample
10415
10416 Changing a
10417 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10418 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10419 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10420 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10421 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10422 declared to have a type such as:
10423
10424 @smallexample
10425 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10426 Id : Integer;
10427 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10428 end record;
10429 @end smallexample
10430
10431 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10432 assignments:
10433
10434 @smallexample
10435 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10436 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10437 @end smallexample
10438
10439 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10440 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10441 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10442 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10443 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10444 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10445 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10446 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10447
10448 @item
10449 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10450
10451 @item
10452 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10453 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10454 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10455 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10456 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10457 the proper resolution.
10458
10459 @item
10460 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10461
10462 @item
10463 Entry calls are not implemented.
10464
10465 @item
10466 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10467 formats are not supported.
10468
10469 @item
10470 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10471 @end itemize
10472
10473 @node Additions to Ada
10474 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10475 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10476
10477 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10478 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10479
10480 @itemize @bullet
10481 @item
10482 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10483 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10484 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10485 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10486 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10487 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10488 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10489 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10490
10491 @item
10492 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10493 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10494 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10495
10496 @item
10497 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10498 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10499
10500 @item
10501 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10502 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10503 @end itemize
10504
10505 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10506 additions specific to Ada:
10507
10508 @itemize @bullet
10509 @item
10510 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10511 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10512
10513 @smallexample
10514 set x := y + 3
10515 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10516 @end smallexample
10517
10518 @item
10519 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10520 the value of its right-hand operand.
10521 This allows, for example,
10522 complex conditional breaks:
10523
10524 @smallexample
10525 break f
10526 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10527 @end smallexample
10528
10529 @item
10530 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10531 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10532 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10533 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10534 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10535 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10536 in strings. For example,
10537 @smallexample
10538 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10539 @end smallexample
10540 @noindent
10541 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10542 after each period.
10543
10544 @item
10545 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10546 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10547 to write
10548
10549 @smallexample
10550 print 'max(x, y)
10551 @end smallexample
10552
10553 @item
10554 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10555 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10556 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10557 of 3 might print as
10558
10559 @smallexample
10560 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10561 @end smallexample
10562
10563 @noindent
10564 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10565 clause.
10566
10567 @item
10568 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10569 multi-character subsequence of
10570 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10571 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10572 in place of @t{a'length}.
10573
10574 @item
10575 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10576 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10577 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10578 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10579 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10580 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10581 For example,
10582 @smallexample
10583 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10584 @end smallexample
10585
10586 @item
10587 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10588 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10589 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10590 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10591 object.
10592
10593 @end itemize
10594
10595 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10596 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10597
10598 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10599 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10600 before reaching the main procedure.
10601 As defined in the Ada Reference
10602 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10603 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10604 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10605 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10606
10607 @node Ada Glitches
10608 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10609 @cindex Ada, problems
10610
10611 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10612 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10613 @value{GDBN},
10614 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10615 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10616
10617 @itemize @bullet
10618 @item
10619 Currently, the debugger
10620 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10621 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10622 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10623 to get it printed properly.
10624
10625 @item
10626 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10627 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10628
10629 @item
10630 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10631 argument lists are treated as positional).
10632
10633 @item
10634 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10635
10636 @item
10637 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10638 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10639 the host machine.
10640
10641 @item
10642 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10643
10644 @item
10645 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10646 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10647 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10648 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10649 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10650 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10651 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10652 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10653 you can usually resolve the confusion
10654 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10655 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10656 @end itemize
10657
10658 @node Unsupported Languages
10659 @section Unsupported Languages
10660
10661 @cindex unsupported languages
10662 @cindex minimal language
10663 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10664 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10665 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10666 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10667 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10668 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10669
10670 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10671 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10672 language.
10673
10674 @node Symbols
10675 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10676
10677 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10678 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10679 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10680 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10681 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10682 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10683 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10684
10685 @cindex symbol names
10686 @cindex names of symbols
10687 @cindex quoting names
10688 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10689 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10690 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10691 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10692 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10693 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10694 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10695 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10696
10697 @smallexample
10698 p 'foo.c'::x
10699 @end smallexample
10700
10701 @noindent
10702 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10703
10704 @table @code
10705 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10706 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10707 @kindex set case-sensitive
10708 @item set case-sensitive on
10709 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10710 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10711 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10712 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10713 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10714 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10715 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10716 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10717 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10718 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10719 case-insensitive matches.
10720
10721 @kindex show case-sensitive
10722 @item show case-sensitive
10723 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10724 lookups.
10725
10726 @kindex info address
10727 @cindex address of a symbol
10728 @item info address @var{symbol}
10729 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10730 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10731 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10732 is always stored.
10733
10734 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10735 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10736 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10737
10738 @kindex info symbol
10739 @cindex symbol from address
10740 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10741 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10742 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10743 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10744 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10745
10746 @smallexample
10747 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10748 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10749 @end smallexample
10750
10751 @noindent
10752 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10753 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10754
10755 @kindex whatis
10756 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10757 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10758 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10759 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10760 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10761 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10762 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10763 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10764 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10765 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10766 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10767
10768 @kindex ptype
10769 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10770 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10771 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10772 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10773
10774 For example, for this variable declaration:
10775
10776 @smallexample
10777 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10778 @end smallexample
10779
10780 @noindent
10781 the two commands give this output:
10782
10783 @smallexample
10784 @group
10785 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10786 type = struct complex
10787 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10788 type = struct complex @{
10789 double real;
10790 double imag;
10791 @}
10792 @end group
10793 @end smallexample
10794
10795 @noindent
10796 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10797 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10798
10799 @cindex incomplete type
10800 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10801 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10802 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10803 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10804 given these declarations:
10805
10806 @smallexample
10807 struct foo;
10808 struct foo *fooptr;
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 @noindent
10812 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10813
10814 @smallexample
10815 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10816 $1 = <incomplete type>
10817 @end smallexample
10818
10819 @noindent
10820 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10821 completely specified.
10822
10823 @kindex info types
10824 @item info types @var{regexp}
10825 @itemx info types
10826 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10827 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10828 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10829 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10830 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10831 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10832 name is @code{value}.
10833
10834 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10835 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10836 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10837
10838 @kindex info scope
10839 @cindex local variables
10840 @item info scope @var{location}
10841 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10842 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10843 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10844 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10845
10846 @smallexample
10847 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10848 Scope for command_line_handler:
10849 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10850 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10851 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10852 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10853 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10854 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10855 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 @noindent
10859 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10860 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10861 collect}.
10862
10863 @kindex info source
10864 @item info source
10865 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10866 the function containing the current point of execution:
10867 @itemize @bullet
10868 @item
10869 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10870 @item
10871 the directory it was compiled in,
10872 @item
10873 its length, in lines,
10874 @item
10875 which programming language it is written in,
10876 @item
10877 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10878 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10879 @item
10880 whether the debugging information includes information about
10881 preprocessor macros.
10882 @end itemize
10883
10884
10885 @kindex info sources
10886 @item info sources
10887 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10888 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10889 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10890
10891 @kindex info functions
10892 @item info functions
10893 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10894
10895 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10896 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10897 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10898 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10899 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10900 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10901 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10902 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10903
10904 @kindex info variables
10905 @item info variables
10906 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10907 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10908
10909 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10910 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10911 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10912 @var{regexp}.
10913
10914 @kindex info classes
10915 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10916 @item info classes
10917 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10918 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10919 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10920 expression.
10921
10922 @kindex info selectors
10923 @item info selectors
10924 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10925 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10926 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10927 expression.
10928
10929 @ignore
10930 This was never implemented.
10931 @kindex info methods
10932 @item info methods
10933 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10934 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10935 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10936 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10937 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10938 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10939 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10940 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10941 @end ignore
10942
10943 @cindex reloading symbols
10944 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10945 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10946 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10947 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10948 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10949
10950 @table @code
10951 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10952 @item set symbol-reloading on
10953 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10954 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10955
10956 @item set symbol-reloading off
10957 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10958 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10959 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10960 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10961 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10962 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10963 name.
10964
10965 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10966 @item show symbol-reloading
10967 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10968 @end table
10969
10970 @cindex opaque data types
10971 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10972 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10973 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10974 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10975 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10976 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10977 another source file. The default is on.
10978
10979 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10980 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10981
10982 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10983 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10984 is printed as follows:
10985 @smallexample
10986 @{<no data fields>@}
10987 @end smallexample
10988
10989 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10990 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10991 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10992
10993 @kindex maint print symbols
10994 @cindex symbol dump
10995 @kindex maint print psymbols
10996 @cindex partial symbol dump
10997 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10998 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10999 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11000 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11001 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11002 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11003 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11004 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11005 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11006 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11007 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11008 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11009 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11010 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11011 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11012 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11013 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11014
11015 @kindex maint info symtabs
11016 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11017 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11018 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11019 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11020 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11021 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11022 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11023
11024 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11025 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11026 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11027 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11028 structure in more detail. For example:
11029
11030 @smallexample
11031 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11032 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11033 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11034 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11035 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11036 readin no
11037 fullname (null)
11038 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11039 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11040 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11041 dependencies (none)
11042 @}
11043 @}
11044 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11045 (@value{GDBP})
11046 @end smallexample
11047 @noindent
11048 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11049 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11050 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11051 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11052 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11053
11054 @smallexample
11055 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11056 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11057 line 1574.
11058 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11059 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11060 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11061 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11062 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11063 dirname (null)
11064 fullname (null)
11065 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11066 debugformat DWARF 2
11067 @}
11068 @}
11069 (@value{GDBP})
11070 @end smallexample
11071 @end table
11072
11073
11074 @node Altering
11075 @chapter Altering Execution
11076
11077 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11078 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11079 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11080 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11081 program.
11082
11083 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11084 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11085 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11086
11087 @menu
11088 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11089 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11090 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11091 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11092 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11093 * Patching:: Patching your program
11094 @end menu
11095
11096 @node Assignment
11097 @section Assignment to Variables
11098
11099 @cindex assignment
11100 @cindex setting variables
11101 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11102 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11103
11104 @smallexample
11105 print x=4
11106 @end smallexample
11107
11108 @noindent
11109 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11110 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11111 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11112 information on operators in supported languages.
11113
11114 @kindex set variable
11115 @cindex variables, setting
11116 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11117 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11118 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11119 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11120 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11121
11122 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11123 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11124 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11125 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11126 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11127 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11128 command @code{set width}:
11129
11130 @smallexample
11131 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11132 type = double
11133 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11134 $4 = 13
11135 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11136 Invalid syntax in expression.
11137 @end smallexample
11138
11139 @noindent
11140 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11141 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11142
11143 @smallexample
11144 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11145 @end smallexample
11146
11147 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11148 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11149 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11150 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11151 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11152 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11153
11154 @smallexample
11155 @group
11156 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11157 type = double
11158 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11159 $1 = 1
11160 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11161 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11162 $2 = 1
11163 (@value{GDBP}) r
11164 The program being debugged has been started already.
11165 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11166 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11167 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11168 Invalid bfd target.
11169 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11170 The current BFD target is "=4".
11171 @end group
11172 @end smallexample
11173
11174 @noindent
11175 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11176 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11177 @code{g}, use
11178
11179 @smallexample
11180 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11181 @end smallexample
11182
11183 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11184 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11185 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11186 same length or shorter.
11187 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11188 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11189
11190 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11191 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11192 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11193 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11194 and representation in memory), and
11195
11196 @smallexample
11197 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11198 @end smallexample
11199
11200 @noindent
11201 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11202
11203 @node Jumping
11204 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11205
11206 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11207 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11208 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11209
11210 @table @code
11211 @kindex jump
11212 @item jump @var{linespec}
11213 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11214 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11215 Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11216 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11217 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11218 Breakpoints}.
11219
11220 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11221 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11222 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11223 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11224 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11225 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11226 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11227 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11228 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11229
11230 @item jump *@var{address}
11231 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11232 @end table
11233
11234 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11235 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11236 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11237 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11238 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11239 example,
11240
11241 @smallexample
11242 set $pc = 0x485
11243 @end smallexample
11244
11245 @noindent
11246 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11247 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11248 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11249
11250 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11251 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11252 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11253 detail.
11254
11255 @c @group
11256 @node Signaling
11257 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11258 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11259
11260 @table @code
11261 @kindex signal
11262 @item signal @var{signal}
11263 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11264 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11265 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11266 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11267
11268 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11269 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11270 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11271 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11272 signal.
11273
11274 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11275 after executing the command.
11276 @end table
11277 @c @end group
11278
11279 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11280 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11281 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11282 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11283 passes the signal directly to your program.
11284
11285
11286 @node Returning
11287 @section Returning from a Function
11288
11289 @table @code
11290 @cindex returning from a function
11291 @kindex return
11292 @item return
11293 @itemx return @var{expression}
11294 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11295 command. If you give an
11296 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11297 value.
11298 @end table
11299
11300 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11301 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11302 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11303 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11304
11305 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11306 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11307 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11308 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11309 of functions.
11310
11311 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11312 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11313 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11314 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11315 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11316
11317 @node Calling
11318 @section Calling Program Functions
11319
11320 @table @code
11321 @cindex calling functions
11322 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11323 @item print @var{expr}
11324 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11325 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11326 debugged.
11327
11328 @kindex call
11329 @item call @var{expr}
11330 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11331 returned values.
11332
11333 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11334 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11335 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11336 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11337 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11338 value history.
11339 @end table
11340
11341 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11342 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11343 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11344 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11345
11346 @table @code
11347 @item set unwindonsignal
11348 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11349 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11350 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11351 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11352 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11353 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11354 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11355 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11356 received.
11357
11358 @item show unwindonsignal
11359 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11360 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11361 @value{GDBN}.
11362 @end table
11363
11364 @cindex weak alias functions
11365 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11366 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11367 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11368 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11369 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11370 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11371 function instead.
11372
11373 @node Patching
11374 @section Patching Programs
11375
11376 @cindex patching binaries
11377 @cindex writing into executables
11378 @cindex writing into corefiles
11379
11380 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11381 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11382 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11383 patching your program's binary.
11384
11385 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11386 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11387 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11388 repairs.
11389
11390 @table @code
11391 @kindex set write
11392 @item set write on
11393 @itemx set write off
11394 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11395 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11396 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11397
11398 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11399 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11400 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11401
11402 @item show write
11403 @kindex show write
11404 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11405 as well as reading.
11406 @end table
11407
11408 @node GDB Files
11409 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11410
11411 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11412 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11413 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11414 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11415
11416 @menu
11417 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11418 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11419 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11420 @end menu
11421
11422 @node Files
11423 @section Commands to Specify Files
11424
11425 @cindex symbol table
11426 @cindex core dump file
11427
11428 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11429 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11430 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11431 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11432
11433 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11434 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11435 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11436 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11437 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11438 new files are useful.
11439
11440 @table @code
11441 @cindex executable file
11442 @kindex file
11443 @item file @var{filename}
11444 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11445 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11446 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11447 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11448 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11449 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11450 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11451 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11452
11453 @cindex unlinked object files
11454 @cindex patching object files
11455 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11456 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11457 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11458 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11459 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11460 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11461 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11462 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11463
11464 @item file
11465 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11466 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11467
11468 @kindex exec-file
11469 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11470 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11471 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11472 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11473 discard information on the executable file.
11474
11475 @kindex symbol-file
11476 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11477 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11478 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11479 table and program to run from the same file.
11480
11481 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11482 program's symbol table.
11483
11484 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11485 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11486 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11487 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11488 @value{GDBN}.
11489
11490 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11491 executing it once.
11492
11493 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11494 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11495 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11496 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11497 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11498 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11499 optimized code.
11500
11501 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11502 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11503 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11504 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11505 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11506
11507 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11508 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11509 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11510 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11511 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11512 Warnings and Messages}.)
11513
11514 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11515 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11516 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11517 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11518 in stabs format.
11519
11520 @kindex readnow
11521 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11522 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11523 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11524 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11525 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11526 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11527 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11528 entire symbol table available.
11529
11530 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11531 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11532 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11533 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11534 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11535 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11536 @c files.
11537
11538 @kindex core-file
11539 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11540 @itemx core
11541 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11542 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11543 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11544 executable file itself for other parts.
11545
11546 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11547 to be used.
11548
11549 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11550 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11551 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11552 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11553 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11554
11555 @kindex add-symbol-file
11556 @cindex dynamic linking
11557 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11558 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11559 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11560 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11561 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11562 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11563 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11564 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11565 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11566 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11567 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11568 @var{address} as an expression.
11569
11570 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11571 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11572 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11573 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11574 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11575
11576 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11577 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11578 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11579 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11580 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11581 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11582 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11583 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11584 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11585
11586 @itemize @bullet
11587 @item
11588 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11589 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11590 @item
11591 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11592 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11593 @item
11594 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11595 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11596 @end itemize
11597
11598 @noindent
11599 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11600 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11601 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11602 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11603 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11604 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11605 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11606 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11607 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11608 way.
11609
11610 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11611
11612 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11613 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11614 @cindex load symbols from memory
11615 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11616 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11617 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11618 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11619 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11620 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11621 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11622 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11623 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11624
11625 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11626 @kindex assf
11627 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11628 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11629 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11630 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11631 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11632 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11633 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11634 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11635 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11636 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11637
11638 @kindex section
11639 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11640 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11641 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11642 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11643 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11644 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11645 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11646 their addresses.
11647
11648 @kindex info files
11649 @kindex info target
11650 @item info files
11651 @itemx info target
11652 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11653 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11654 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11655 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11656 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11657 current ones.
11658
11659 @kindex maint info sections
11660 @item maint info sections
11661 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11662 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11663 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11664 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11665 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11666 may be arbitrarily combined):
11667
11668 @table @code
11669 @item ALLOBJ
11670 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11671 @item @var{sections}
11672 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11673 @item @var{section-flags}
11674 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11675 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11676 @table @code
11677 @item ALLOC
11678 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11679 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11680 @item LOAD
11681 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11682 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11683 @item RELOC
11684 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11685 @item READONLY
11686 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11687 @item CODE
11688 Section contains executable code only.
11689 @item DATA
11690 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11691 @item ROM
11692 Section will reside in ROM.
11693 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11694 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11695 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11696 Section is not empty.
11697 @item NEVER_LOAD
11698 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11699 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11700 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11701 COFF shared library information.
11702 @item IS_COMMON
11703 Section contains common symbols.
11704 @end table
11705 @end table
11706 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11707 @cindex read-only sections
11708 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11709 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11710 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11711 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11712 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11713 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11714 enhancement to debugging performance.
11715
11716 The default is off.
11717
11718 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11719 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11720 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11721 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11722
11723 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11724 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11725 @end table
11726
11727 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11728 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11729 name and remembers it that way.
11730
11731 @cindex shared libraries
11732 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11733 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11734
11735 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11736 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11737 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11738 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11739 debugging a core file).
11740
11741 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11742 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11743
11744 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11745 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11746 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11747
11748 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11749 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11750 particularly large or there are many of them.
11751
11752 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11753 commands:
11754
11755 @table @code
11756 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11757 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11758 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11759 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11760 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11761 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11762 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11763 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11764
11765 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11766 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11767 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11768 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11769 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11770 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11771 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11772 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11773 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11774
11775 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11776 @item show auto-solib-add
11777 Display the current autoloading mode.
11778 @end table
11779
11780 @cindex load shared library
11781 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11782 command:
11783
11784 @table @code
11785 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11786 @kindex info share
11787 @item info share
11788 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11789 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11790
11791 @kindex sharedlibrary
11792 @kindex share
11793 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11794 @itemx share @var{regex}
11795 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11796 Unix regular expression.
11797 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11798 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11799 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11800 loaded.
11801
11802 @item nosharedlibrary
11803 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11804 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11805 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11806 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11807 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11808 discarded.
11809 @end table
11810
11811 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11812 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11813 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11814
11815 @table @code
11816 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11817 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11818 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11819 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11820 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11821 shared library.
11822
11823 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11824 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11825 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11826 library events happen.
11827 @end table
11828
11829 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11830 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11831 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11832 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11833 not.
11834
11835 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11836 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11837 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11838 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11839 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11840
11841 @table @code
11842 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11843 @cindex system root, alternate
11844 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11845 @kindex set sysroot
11846 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11847 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11848 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11849 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11850 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11851 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11852 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11853 under @var{path}.
11854
11855 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11856 sysroot}.
11857
11858 @cindex default system root
11859 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11860 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11861 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11862 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11863 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11864 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11865 location.
11866
11867 @kindex show sysroot
11868 @item show sysroot
11869 Display the current shared library prefix.
11870
11871 @kindex set solib-search-path
11872 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11873 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11874 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11875 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11876 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11877 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11878 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11879 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11880 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
11881 of shared library symbols.
11882
11883 @kindex show solib-search-path
11884 @item show solib-search-path
11885 Display the current shared library search path.
11886 @end table
11887
11888
11889 @node Separate Debug Files
11890 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11891 @cindex separate debugging information files
11892 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11893 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11894 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11895 @cindex global debugging information directory
11896
11897 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11898 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11899 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11900 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11901 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11902 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11903 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11904
11905 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11906 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11907 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11908 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11909 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11910 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11911 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11912 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11913 places:
11914
11915 @itemize @bullet
11916 @item
11917 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11918 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11919 @item
11920 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11921 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11922 @item
11923 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11924 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11925 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11926 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11927 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11928 @end itemize
11929 @noindent
11930 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11931 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11932 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11933
11934 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11935 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11936 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11937 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11938 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11939 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11940
11941 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11942 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11943
11944 @table @code
11945
11946 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11947 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11948 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11949 information files to @var{directory}.
11950
11951 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11952 @item show debug-file-directory
11953 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11954 information files.
11955
11956 @end table
11957
11958 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11959 @cindex debug links
11960 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11961 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11962
11963 @itemize
11964 @item
11965 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11966 a zero byte,
11967 @item
11968 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11969 boundary within the section, and
11970 @item
11971 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11972 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11973 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11974 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11975 @end itemize
11976
11977 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11978 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11979 described above.
11980
11981 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11982 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11983 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11984 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11985 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11986 in an ordinary executable.
11987
11988 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11989 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11990 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11991 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11992 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11993 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11994 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11995
11996 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11997 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11998 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11999 complete code for a function that computes it:
12000
12001 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12002 @smallexample
12003 unsigned long
12004 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12005 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12006 @{
12007 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12008 @{
12009 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12010 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12011 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12012 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12013 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12014 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12015 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12016 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12017 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12018 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12019 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12020 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12021 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12022 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12023 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12024 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12025 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12026 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12027 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12028 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12029 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12030 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12031 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12032 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12033 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12034 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12035 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12036 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12037 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12038 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12039 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12040 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12041 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12042 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12043 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12044 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12045 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12046 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12047 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12048 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12049 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12050 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12051 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12052 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12053 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12054 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12055 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12056 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12057 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12058 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12059 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12060 0x2d02ef8d
12061 @};
12062 unsigned char *end;
12063
12064 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12065 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12066 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12067 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12068 @}
12069 @end smallexample
12070
12071
12072 @node Symbol Errors
12073 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12074
12075 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12076 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12077 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12078 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12079 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12080 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12081 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12082 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12083 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12084 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12085 Messages}).
12086
12087 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12088
12089 @table @code
12090 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12091
12092 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12093 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12094 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12095 in its outer scope blocks.
12096
12097 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12098 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12099 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12100 function.
12101
12102 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12103
12104 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12105 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12106 do so.
12107
12108 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12109 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12110 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12111 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12112 Messages}.)
12113
12114 @item bad block start address patched
12115
12116 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12117 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12118 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12119
12120 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12121 starting on the previous source line.
12122
12123 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12124
12125 @cindex foo
12126 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12127 larger than the size of the string table.
12128
12129 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12130 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12131 with this name.
12132
12133 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12134
12135 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12136 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12137 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12138
12139 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12140 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12141 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12142 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12143 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12144 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12145
12146 @item stub type has NULL name
12147
12148 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12149
12150 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12151 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12152 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12153 it.
12154
12155 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12156
12157 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12158
12159 @end table
12160
12161 @node Targets
12162 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12163
12164 @cindex debugging target
12165 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12166
12167 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12168 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12169 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12170 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12171 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12172 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12173 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12174 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12175
12176 @cindex target architecture
12177 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12178 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12179 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12180 command.
12181
12182 @table @code
12183 @kindex set architecture
12184 @kindex show architecture
12185 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12186 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12187 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12188 supported architectures.
12189
12190 @item show architecture
12191 Show the current target architecture.
12192
12193 @item set processor
12194 @itemx processor
12195 @kindex set processor
12196 @kindex show processor
12197 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12198 and @code{show architecture}.
12199 @end table
12200
12201 @menu
12202 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12203 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12204 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12205 @end menu
12206
12207 @node Active Targets
12208 @section Active Targets
12209
12210 @cindex stacking targets
12211 @cindex active targets
12212 @cindex multiple targets
12213
12214 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12215 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12216 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12217 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12218 a core file.
12219
12220 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12221 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12222 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12223 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12224 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12225 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12226 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12227 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12228 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12229
12230 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12231 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12232 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12233 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12234 process target is active.
12235
12236 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12237 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12238 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12239 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12240 Process}).
12241
12242 @node Target Commands
12243 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12244
12245 @table @code
12246 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12247 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12248 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12249 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12250 protocol of the target machine.
12251
12252 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12253 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12254 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12255
12256 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12257 after executing the command.
12258
12259 @kindex help target
12260 @item help target
12261 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12262 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12263 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12264
12265 @item help target @var{name}
12266 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12267 select it.
12268
12269 @kindex set gnutarget
12270 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12271 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12272 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12273 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12274 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12275 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12276
12277 @quotation
12278 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12279 you must know the actual BFD name.
12280 @end quotation
12281
12282 @noindent
12283 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12284
12285 @kindex show gnutarget
12286 @item show gnutarget
12287 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12288 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12289 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12290 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12291 @end table
12292
12293 @cindex common targets
12294 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12295 configuration):
12296
12297 @table @code
12298 @kindex target
12299 @item target exec @var{program}
12300 @cindex executable file target
12301 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12302 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12303
12304 @item target core @var{filename}
12305 @cindex core dump file target
12306 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12307 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12308
12309 @item target remote @var{medium}
12310 @cindex remote target
12311 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12312 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12313 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12314
12315 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12316 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12317
12318 @smallexample
12319 target remote /dev/ttya
12320 @end smallexample
12321
12322 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12323 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12324 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12325 clobbered by the download.
12326
12327 @item target sim
12328 @cindex built-in simulator target
12329 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12330 In general,
12331 @smallexample
12332 target sim
12333 load
12334 run
12335 @end smallexample
12336 @noindent
12337 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12338 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12339 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12340 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12341 Processors}.
12342
12343 @end table
12344
12345 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12346
12347 @table @code
12348
12349 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12350 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12351 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12352
12353 @end table
12354
12355 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12356 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12357
12358 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12359 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12360 various aspects of this process.
12361
12362 @table @code
12363
12364 @item set hash
12365 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12366 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12367 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12368 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12369 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12370 monitor.
12371
12372 @item show hash
12373 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12374 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12375
12376 @item set debug monitor
12377 @kindex set debug monitor
12378 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12379 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12380 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12381
12382 @item show debug monitor
12383 @kindex show debug monitor
12384 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12385 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12386 @end table
12387
12388 @table @code
12389
12390 @kindex load @var{filename}
12391 @item load @var{filename}
12392 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12393 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12394 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12395 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12396 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12397 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12398
12399 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12400 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12401 target is @dots{}}''
12402
12403 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12404 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12405 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12406 specifies a fixed address.
12407 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12408
12409 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12410 load programs into flash memory.
12411
12412 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12413 @end table
12414
12415 @node Byte Order
12416 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12417
12418 @cindex choosing target byte order
12419 @cindex target byte order
12420
12421 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12422 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12423 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12424 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12425 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12426 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12427
12428 @table @code
12429 @kindex set endian
12430 @item set endian big
12431 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12432
12433 @item set endian little
12434 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12435
12436 @item set endian auto
12437 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12438 executable.
12439
12440 @item show endian
12441 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12442
12443 @end table
12444
12445 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12446 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12447 target system.
12448
12449
12450 @node Remote Debugging
12451 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12452 @cindex remote debugging
12453
12454 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12455 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12456 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12457 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12458 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12459
12460 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12461 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12462 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12463 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12464 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12465 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12466
12467 Other remote targets may be available in your
12468 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12469
12470 @menu
12471 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12472 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12473 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12474 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12475 @end menu
12476
12477 @node Connecting
12478 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12479
12480 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12481 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12482 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12483 program as the first argument.
12484
12485 @cindex @code{target remote}
12486 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12487 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12488 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12489 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12490 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12491 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12492
12493 @table @code
12494
12495 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12496 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12497 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12498 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12499
12500 @smallexample
12501 target remote /dev/ttyb
12502 @end smallexample
12503
12504 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12505 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12506 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12507 @code{target} command.
12508
12509 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12510 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12511 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12512 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12513 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12514 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12515 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12516 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12517 target.
12518
12519 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12520 @code{manyfarms}:
12521
12522 @smallexample
12523 target remote manyfarms:2828
12524 @end smallexample
12525
12526 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12527 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12528 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12529 port 1234 on your local machine:
12530
12531 @smallexample
12532 target remote :1234
12533 @end smallexample
12534 @noindent
12535
12536 Note that the colon is still required here.
12537
12538 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12539 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12540 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12541 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12542
12543 @smallexample
12544 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12545 @end smallexample
12546
12547 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12548 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12549 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12550 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12551
12552 @item target remote | @var{command}
12553 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12554 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12555 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12556 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12557 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12558 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12559 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12560 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12561
12562 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12563 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12564 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12565
12566 @end table
12567
12568 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12569 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12570 remote program.
12571
12572 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12573 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12574 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12575 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12576 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12577 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12578 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12579
12580 @smallexample
12581 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12582 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12583 @end smallexample
12584
12585 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12586 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12587 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12588 goes back to waiting.
12589
12590 @table @code
12591 @kindex detach (remote)
12592 @item detach
12593 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12594 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12595 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12596 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12597 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12598
12599 @kindex disconnect
12600 @item disconnect
12601 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12602 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12603 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12604 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12605 another target.
12606
12607 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12608 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12609 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12610 @kindex monitor
12611 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12612 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12613 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12614 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12615 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12616 and implement.
12617 @end table
12618
12619 @node Server
12620 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12621
12622 @kindex gdbserver
12623 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12624 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12625 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12626 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12627
12628 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12629 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12630 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12631 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12632 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12633 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12634 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12635 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12636 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12637 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12638 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12639 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12640 choice for debugging.
12641
12642 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12643 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12644 protocol.
12645
12646 @table @emph
12647 @item On the target machine,
12648 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12649 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12650 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12651 system does all the symbol handling.
12652
12653 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12654 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12655 syntax is:
12656
12657 @smallexample
12658 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12659 @end smallexample
12660
12661 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12662 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12663 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12664 @file{/dev/com1}:
12665
12666 @smallexample
12667 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12668 @end smallexample
12669
12670 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12671 with it.
12672
12673 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12674
12675 @smallexample
12676 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12677 @end smallexample
12678
12679 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12680 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12681 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12682 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12683 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12684 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12685 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12686 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12687 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12688 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12689 @code{target remote} command.
12690
12691 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12692 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12693
12694 @smallexample
12695 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12696 @end smallexample
12697
12698 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12699 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12700
12701 @pindex pidof
12702 @cindex attach to a program by name
12703 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12704 @code{pidof} utility:
12705
12706 @smallexample
12707 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12708 @end smallexample
12709
12710 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12711 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12712 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12713
12714 @item On the host machine,
12715 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12716 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12717 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12718 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12719
12720 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12721 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12722 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12723 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12724 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12725 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12726 programs.
12727
12728 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12729 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12730 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12731 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12732 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12733 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12734 already on the target.
12735
12736 @end table
12737
12738 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
12739 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12740
12741 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12742 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12743 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12744 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12745
12746 @table @code
12747 @item monitor help
12748 List the available monitor commands.
12749
12750 @item monitor set debug 0
12751 @itemx monitor set debug 1
12752 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12753
12754 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
12755 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12756 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12757 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12758
12759 @end table
12760
12761 @node Remote Configuration
12762 @section Remote Configuration
12763
12764 @kindex set remote
12765 @kindex show remote
12766 This section documents the configuration options available when
12767 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12768 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12769 system-call-allowed}.
12770
12771 @table @code
12772 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12773 @cindex address size for remote targets
12774 @cindex bits in remote address
12775 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12776 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12777 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12778 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12779
12780 @item show remoteaddresssize
12781 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12782
12783 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12784 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12785 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12786 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12787 remote targets.
12788
12789 @item show remotebaud
12790 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12791
12792 @item set remotebreak
12793 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12794 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12795 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12796 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12797 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12798 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12799 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12800 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12801
12802 @item show remotebreak
12803 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12804 interrupt the remote program.
12805
12806 @item set remoteflow on
12807 @itemx set remoteflow off
12808 @kindex set remoteflow
12809 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
12810 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
12811
12812 @item show remoteflow
12813 @kindex show remoteflow
12814 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
12815
12816 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12817 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12818 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12819 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12820 @code{ascii}.
12821
12822 @item show remotelogbase
12823 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12824 protocol.
12825
12826 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12827 @cindex record serial communications on file
12828 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12829 default is not to record at all.
12830
12831 @item show remotelogfile.
12832 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12833 serial communications.
12834
12835 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12836 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12837 @cindex remote timeout
12838 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12839 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12840
12841 @item show remotetimeout
12842 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12843 responses.
12844
12845 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12846 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12847 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12848 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12849 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12850 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12851 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12852 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12853 @end table
12854
12855 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12856 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12857 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12858 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12859 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12860 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12861 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12862 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12863 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12864
12865 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12866 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12867 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12868 @value{GDBN} developers.
12869
12870 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
12871 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
12872 are:
12873
12874 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
12875 @item Command Name
12876 @tab Remote Packet
12877 @tab Related Features
12878
12879 @item @code{fetch-register}
12880 @tab @code{p}
12881 @tab @code{info registers}
12882
12883 @item @code{set-register}
12884 @tab @code{P}
12885 @tab @code{set}
12886
12887 @item @code{binary-download}
12888 @tab @code{X}
12889 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12890
12891 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
12892 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12893 @tab @code{info auxv}
12894
12895 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
12896 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12897 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12898
12899 @item @code{verbose-resume}
12900 @tab @code{vCont}
12901 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12902
12903 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
12904 @tab @code{Z0}
12905 @tab @code{break}
12906
12907 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
12908 @tab @code{Z1}
12909 @tab @code{hbreak}
12910
12911 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
12912 @tab @code{Z2}
12913 @tab @code{watch}
12914
12915 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
12916 @tab @code{Z3}
12917 @tab @code{rwatch}
12918
12919 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
12920 @tab @code{Z4}
12921 @tab @code{awatch}
12922
12923 @item @code{target-features}
12924 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
12925 @tab @code{set architecture}
12926
12927 @item @code{library-info}
12928 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
12929 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
12930
12931 @item @code{memory-map}
12932 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
12933 @tab @code{info mem}
12934
12935 @item @code{read-spu-object}
12936 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
12937 @tab @code{info spu}
12938
12939 @item @code{write-spu-object}
12940 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
12941 @tab @code{info spu}
12942
12943 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
12944 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12945 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12946
12947 @item @code{supported-packets}
12948 @tab @code{qSupported}
12949 @tab Remote communications parameters
12950
12951 @item @code{pass-signals}
12952 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12953 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12954
12955 @end multitable
12956
12957 @node Remote Stub
12958 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
12959
12960 @cindex debugging stub, example
12961 @cindex remote stub, example
12962 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12963 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12964 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12965 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12966 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12967 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12968 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12969 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12970
12971 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12972 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12973 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12974 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12975 program, you need:
12976
12977 @enumerate
12978 @item
12979 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12980 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12981 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12982
12983 @item
12984 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12985 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12986
12987 @item
12988 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12989 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12990 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12991 documentation.
12992 @end enumerate
12993
12994 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12995 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12996 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12997
12998 @table @emph
12999 @item On the host,
13000 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13001 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13002 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13003
13004 @item On the target,
13005 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13006 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13007 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13008
13009 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13010 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13011 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13012 @end table
13013
13014 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13015 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13016 @sc{sparc} boards.
13017
13018 @cindex remote serial stub list
13019 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13020
13021 @table @code
13022
13023 @item i386-stub.c
13024 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13025 @cindex Intel
13026 @cindex i386
13027 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13028
13029 @item m68k-stub.c
13030 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13031 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13032 @cindex m680x0
13033 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13034
13035 @item sh-stub.c
13036 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13037 @cindex Renesas
13038 @cindex SH
13039 For Renesas SH architectures.
13040
13041 @item sparc-stub.c
13042 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13043 @cindex Sparc
13044 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13045
13046 @item sparcl-stub.c
13047 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13048 @cindex Fujitsu
13049 @cindex SparcLite
13050 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13051
13052 @end table
13053
13054 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13055 recently added stubs.
13056
13057 @menu
13058 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13059 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13060 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13061 @end menu
13062
13063 @node Stub Contents
13064 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13065
13066 @cindex remote serial stub
13067 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13068 subroutines:
13069
13070 @table @code
13071 @item set_debug_traps
13072 @findex set_debug_traps
13073 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13074 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13075 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13076 beginning of your program.
13077
13078 @item handle_exception
13079 @findex handle_exception
13080 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13081 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13082 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13083 run when a trap is triggered.
13084
13085 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13086 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13087 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13088 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13089 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13090 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13091 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13092 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13093 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13094 machine.
13095
13096 @item breakpoint
13097 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13098 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13099 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13100 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13101 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13102 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13103 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13104 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13105 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13106 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13107 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13108
13109 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13110 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13111 start of your debugging session.
13112 @end table
13113
13114 @node Bootstrapping
13115 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13116
13117 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13118 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13119 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13120 debugging target machine.
13121
13122 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13123 serial port.
13124
13125 @table @code
13126 @item int getDebugChar()
13127 @findex getDebugChar
13128 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13129 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13130 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13131
13132 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13133 @findex putDebugChar
13134 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13135 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13136 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13137 @end table
13138
13139 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13140 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13141 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13142 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13143 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13144 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13145 remote system to stop.
13146
13147 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13148 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13149 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13150 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13151
13152 Other routines you need to supply are:
13153
13154 @table @code
13155 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13156 @findex exceptionHandler
13157 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13158 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13159 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13160 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13161 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13162 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13163 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13164 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13165 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13166 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13167 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13168 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13169 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13170
13171 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13172 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13173 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13174 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13175 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13176
13177 @item void flush_i_cache()
13178 @findex flush_i_cache
13179 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13180 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13181 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13182
13183 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13184 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13185 @end table
13186
13187 @noindent
13188 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13189
13190 @table @code
13191 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13192 @findex memset
13193 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13194 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13195 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13196 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13197 @end table
13198
13199 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13200 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13201 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13202 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13203
13204
13205 @node Debug Session
13206 @subsection Putting it All Together
13207
13208 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13209 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13210 steps.
13211
13212 @enumerate
13213 @item
13214 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13215 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13216 @display
13217 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13218 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13219 @end display
13220
13221 @item
13222 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13223
13224 @smallexample
13225 set_debug_traps();
13226 breakpoint();
13227 @end smallexample
13228
13229 @item
13230 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13231 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13232
13233 @smallexample
13234 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13235 @end smallexample
13236
13237 @noindent
13238 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13239 function in your program, that function is called when
13240 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13241 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13242 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13243
13244 @item
13245 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13246 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13247
13248 @item
13249 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13250 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13251
13252 @item
13253 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13254 @c document that. FIXME.
13255 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13256 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13257
13258 @item
13259 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13260 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13261
13262 @end enumerate
13263
13264 @node Configurations
13265 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13266
13267 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13268 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13269 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13270
13271 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13272 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13273 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13274 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13275 are quite different from each other.
13276
13277 @menu
13278 * Native::
13279 * Embedded OS::
13280 * Embedded Processors::
13281 * Architectures::
13282 @end menu
13283
13284 @node Native
13285 @section Native
13286
13287 This section describes details specific to particular native
13288 configurations.
13289
13290 @menu
13291 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13292 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13293 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13294 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13295 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13296 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13297 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13298 @end menu
13299
13300 @node HP-UX
13301 @subsection HP-UX
13302
13303 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13304 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13305 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13306
13307
13308 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13309 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13310
13311 @cindex libkvm
13312 @cindex kernel memory image
13313 @cindex kernel crash dump
13314
13315 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13316 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13317 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13318 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13319 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13320 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13321 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13322 @code{kvm} target:
13323
13324 @smallexample
13325 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13326 @end smallexample
13327
13328 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13329 argument:
13330
13331 @smallexample
13332 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13333 @end smallexample
13334
13335 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13336 available:
13337
13338 @table @code
13339 @kindex kvm
13340 @item kvm pcb
13341 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13342
13343 @item kvm proc
13344 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13345 modern FreeBSD systems.
13346 @end table
13347
13348 @node SVR4 Process Information
13349 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13350 @cindex /proc
13351 @cindex examine process image
13352 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13353
13354 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13355 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13356 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13357 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13358 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13359 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13360 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13361 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13362 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13363
13364 @table @code
13365 @kindex info proc
13366 @cindex process ID
13367 @item info proc
13368 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13369 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13370 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13371 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13372 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13373 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13374 executable file's absolute file name.
13375
13376 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13377 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13378 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13379 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13380 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13381 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13382
13383 @item info proc mappings
13384 @cindex memory address space mappings
13385 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13386 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13387 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13388 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13389 memory access rights to that range.
13390
13391 @item info proc stat
13392 @itemx info proc status
13393 @cindex process detailed status information
13394 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13395 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13396 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13397 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13398 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13399 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13400 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13401
13402 @item info proc all
13403 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13404 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13405
13406 @ignore
13407 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13408 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13409 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13410 @kindex info proc times
13411 @item info proc times
13412 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13413 its children.
13414
13415 @kindex info proc id
13416 @item info proc id
13417 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13418 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13419 @end ignore
13420
13421 @item set procfs-trace
13422 @kindex set procfs-trace
13423 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13424 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13425
13426 @item show procfs-trace
13427 @kindex show procfs-trace
13428 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13429
13430 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13431 @kindex set procfs-file
13432 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13433 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13434 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13435 standard output.
13436
13437 @item show procfs-file
13438 @kindex show procfs-file
13439 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13440
13441 @item proc-trace-entry
13442 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13443 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13444 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13445 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13446 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13447 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13448 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13449 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13450 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13451
13452 @item info pidlist
13453 @kindex info pidlist
13454 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13455 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13456 processes and all the threads within each process.
13457
13458 @item info meminfo
13459 @kindex info meminfo
13460 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13461 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13462 @end table
13463
13464 @node DJGPP Native
13465 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13466 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13467 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13468 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13469
13470 @cindex DPMI
13471 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13472 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13473 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13474 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13475
13476 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13477 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13478 subsection describes those commands.
13479
13480 @table @code
13481 @kindex info dos
13482 @item info dos
13483 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13484 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13485
13486 @kindex sysinfo
13487 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13488 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13489 @item info dos sysinfo
13490 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13491 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13492 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13493
13494 @cindex GDT
13495 @cindex LDT
13496 @cindex IDT
13497 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13498 @cindex descriptor tables display
13499 @item info dos gdt
13500 @itemx info dos ldt
13501 @itemx info dos idt
13502 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13503 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13504 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13505 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13506 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13507 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13508 rights.
13509
13510 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13511 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13512 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13513 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13514 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13515
13516 @cindex garbled pointers
13517 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13518 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13519 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13520 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13521 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13522 debugged program's data segment:
13523
13524 @smallexample
13525 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13526 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13527 @end smallexample
13528
13529 @noindent
13530 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13531 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13532
13533 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13534 @item info dos pde
13535 @itemx info dos pte
13536 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13537 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13538 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13539 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13540 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13541 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13542 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13543 that is currently in use.
13544
13545 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13546 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13547 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13548 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13549 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13550 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13551 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13552
13553 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13554 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13555 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13556 controller.
13557
13558 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13559
13560 @cindex physical address from linear address
13561 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13562 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13563 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13564 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13565 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13566 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13567 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13568
13569 @smallexample
13570 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13571 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13572 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13573 @end smallexample
13574
13575 @noindent
13576 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13577 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13578 attributes of that page.
13579
13580 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13581 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13582 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13583 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13584 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13585 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13586
13587 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13588 transfer buffer:
13589
13590 @smallexample
13591 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13592 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13593 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13594 @end smallexample
13595
13596 @noindent
13597 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13598 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13599 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13600 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13601 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13602
13603 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13604 @end table
13605
13606 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13607 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13608 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13609 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13610
13611 @table @code
13612 @kindex set com1base
13613 @kindex set com1irq
13614 @kindex set com2base
13615 @kindex set com2irq
13616 @kindex set com3base
13617 @kindex set com3irq
13618 @kindex set com4base
13619 @kindex set com4irq
13620 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13621 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13622 port.
13623
13624 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13625 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13626 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13627
13628 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13629 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13630 other 3 COM ports.
13631
13632 @kindex show com1base
13633 @kindex show com1irq
13634 @kindex show com2base
13635 @kindex show com2irq
13636 @kindex show com3base
13637 @kindex show com3irq
13638 @kindex show com4base
13639 @kindex show com4irq
13640 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13641 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13642 lines used by the COM ports.
13643
13644 @item info serial
13645 @kindex info serial
13646 @cindex DOS serial port status
13647 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13648 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13649 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13650 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13651 @end table
13652
13653
13654 @node Cygwin Native
13655 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13656 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13657 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13658 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13659
13660 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13661 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13662 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13663 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13664 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13665
13666 @table @code
13667 @kindex info w32
13668 @item info w32
13669 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13670 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13671
13672 @item info w32 selector
13673 This command displays information returned by
13674 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13675 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13676 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13677 Without argument, this command displays information
13678 about the six segment registers.
13679
13680 @kindex info dll
13681 @item info dll
13682 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13683
13684 @kindex dll-symbols
13685 @item dll-symbols
13686 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13687 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13688
13689 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13690 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13691 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13692 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13693 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13694 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13695 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13696 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13697 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13698 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13699 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13700
13701 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13702 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13703 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13704 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13705
13706 @kindex set new-console
13707 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13708 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13709 be started in a new console on next start.
13710 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13711 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13712
13713 @kindex show new-console
13714 @item show new-console
13715 Displays whether a new console is used
13716 when the debuggee is started.
13717
13718 @kindex set new-group
13719 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13720 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13721 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13722 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13723 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13724
13725 @kindex show new-group
13726 @item show new-group
13727 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13728
13729 @kindex set debugevents
13730 @item set debugevents
13731 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13732 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13733 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13734 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13735 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13736
13737 @kindex set debugexec
13738 @item set debugexec
13739 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13740 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13741
13742 @kindex set debugexceptions
13743 @item set debugexceptions
13744 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13745 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13746
13747 @kindex set debugmemory
13748 @item set debugmemory
13749 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13750 and writes by the debugger.
13751
13752 @kindex set shell
13753 @item set shell
13754 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13755 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13756
13757 @kindex show shell
13758 @item show shell
13759 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13760
13761 @end table
13762
13763 @menu
13764 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13765 @end menu
13766
13767 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
13768 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
13769 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13770 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13771
13772 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13773 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13774 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13775 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13776 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
13777 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13778 ``minimal symbols''.
13779
13780 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13781 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13782 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13783 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13784 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13785 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13786 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13787 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13788 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13789 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13790
13791 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
13792
13793 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13794 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13795 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13796 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13797 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13798 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13799 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13800 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13801 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13802
13803 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13804 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13805 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13806 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13807 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
13808 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13809
13810 @smallexample
13811 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13812 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13813
13814 Non-debugging symbols:
13815 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13816 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13817 @end smallexample
13818
13819 @smallexample
13820 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13821 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13822
13823 Non-debugging symbols:
13824 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13825 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13826 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13827 [etc...]
13828 @end smallexample
13829
13830 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
13831
13832 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13833 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13834 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13835 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13836 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13837 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13838 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13839
13840 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13841 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13842 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13843 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13844 problem:
13845
13846 @smallexample
13847 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13848 $1 = 268572168
13849 @end smallexample
13850
13851 @smallexample
13852 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13853 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13854 @end smallexample
13855
13856 And two possible solutions:
13857
13858 @smallexample
13859 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13860 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13861 @end smallexample
13862
13863 @smallexample
13864 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13865 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13866 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13867 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13868 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13869 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13870 @end smallexample
13871
13872 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13873 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13874 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13875 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13876 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13877
13878 @smallexample
13879 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13880 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13881 @end smallexample
13882
13883 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13884 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13885 safe.
13886
13887 @node Hurd Native
13888 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
13889 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13890
13891 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13892 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13893
13894 @table @code
13895 @item set signals
13896 @itemx set sigs
13897 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13898 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13899 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13900 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13901 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13902 @code{signals}.
13903
13904 @item show signals
13905 @itemx show sigs
13906 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13907 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13908 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13909
13910 @item set signal-thread
13911 @itemx set sigthread
13912 @kindex set signal-thread
13913 @kindex set sigthread
13914 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13915 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13916 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13917 signal-thread}.
13918
13919 @item show signal-thread
13920 @itemx show sigthread
13921 @kindex show signal-thread
13922 @kindex show sigthread
13923 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13924 delivered a signal.
13925
13926 @item set stopped
13927 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13928 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13929 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13930 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13931
13932 @item show stopped
13933 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13934 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13935 stopped.
13936
13937 @item set exceptions
13938 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13939 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13940 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13941 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13942 trapping on.
13943
13944 @item show exceptions
13945 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13946 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13947
13948 @item set task pause
13949 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13950 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13951 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13952 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13953 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13954 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13955 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13956 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13957 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13958
13959 @item show task pause
13960 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13961 Show the current state of task suspension.
13962
13963 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13964 @cindex task suspend count
13965 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13966 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13967 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13968
13969 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13970 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13971
13972 @item set task exception-port
13973 @itemx set task excp
13974 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13975 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13976 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13977 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13978
13979 @item set noninvasive
13980 @cindex noninvasive task options
13981 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13982 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13983 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13984 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13985
13986 @item info send-rights
13987 @itemx info receive-rights
13988 @itemx info port-rights
13989 @itemx info port-sets
13990 @itemx info dead-names
13991 @itemx info ports
13992 @itemx info psets
13993 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13994 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13995 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13996 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13997 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13998 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13999 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14000 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14001 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14002
14003 @item set thread pause
14004 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14005 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14006 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14007 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14008 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14009 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14010 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14011 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14012 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14013 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14014 only the current thread.
14015
14016 @item show thread pause
14017 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14018 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14019
14020 @item set thread run
14021 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14022
14023 @item show thread run
14024 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14025
14026 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14027 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14028 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14029 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14030 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14031 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14032 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14033
14034 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14035 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14036 detaching.
14037
14038 @item set thread exception-port
14039 @itemx set thread excp
14040 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14041 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14042 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14043
14044 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14045 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14046 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14047 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14048
14049 @item set thread default
14050 @itemx show thread default
14051 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14052 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14053 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14054 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14055 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14056 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14057 the non-default commands.
14058 @end table
14059
14060
14061 @node Neutrino
14062 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14063 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14064
14065 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14066 Neutrino target:
14067
14068 @table @code
14069 @item set debug nto-debug
14070 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14071 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14072 Neutrino support.
14073
14074 @item show debug nto-debug
14075 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14076 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14077 @end table
14078
14079
14080 @node Embedded OS
14081 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14082
14083 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14084 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14085 architectures.
14086
14087 @menu
14088 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14089 @end menu
14090
14091 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14092 various real-time operating systems.
14093
14094 @node VxWorks
14095 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14096
14097 @cindex VxWorks
14098
14099 @table @code
14100
14101 @kindex target vxworks
14102 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14103 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14104 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14105
14106 @end table
14107
14108 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14109 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14110
14111 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14112 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14113 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14114 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14115 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14116 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14117 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14118
14119 @table @code
14120 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14121 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14122 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14123 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14124 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14125 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14126 of a thin network line.
14127 @end table
14128
14129 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14130 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14131 procedures.
14132
14133 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14134 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14135 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14136 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14137 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14138 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14139 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14140 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14141 manual.
14142 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14143
14144 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14145 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14146 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14147 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14148
14149 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14150
14151 @smallexample
14152 (vxgdb)
14153 @end smallexample
14154
14155 @menu
14156 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14157 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14158 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14159 @end menu
14160
14161 @node VxWorks Connection
14162 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14163
14164 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14165 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14166
14167 @smallexample
14168 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14169 @end smallexample
14170
14171 @need 750
14172 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14173
14174 @smallexample
14175 Attaching remote machine across net...
14176 Connected to tt.
14177 @end smallexample
14178
14179 @need 1000
14180 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14181 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14182 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14183 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14184 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14185
14186 @smallexample
14187 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14188 @end smallexample
14189
14190 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14191 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14192 command again.
14193
14194 @node VxWorks Download
14195 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14196
14197 @cindex download to VxWorks
14198 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14199 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14200 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14201 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14202 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14203 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14204 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14205 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14206 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14207 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14208 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14209 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14210 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14211 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14212 program, type this on VxWorks:
14213
14214 @smallexample
14215 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14216 @end smallexample
14217
14218 @noindent
14219 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14220
14221 @smallexample
14222 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14223 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14224 @end smallexample
14225
14226 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14227
14228 @smallexample
14229 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14230 @end smallexample
14231
14232 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14233 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14234 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14235 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14236 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14237 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14238 table.)
14239
14240 @node VxWorks Attach
14241 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14242
14243 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14244 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14245 follows:
14246
14247 @smallexample
14248 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14249 @end smallexample
14250
14251 @noindent
14252 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14253 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14254 the time of attachment.
14255
14256 @node Embedded Processors
14257 @section Embedded Processors
14258
14259 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14260 configurations.
14261
14262 @cindex send command to simulator
14263 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14264 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14265
14266 @table @code
14267 @item sim @var{command}
14268 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14269 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14270 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14271 acceptable commands.
14272 @end table
14273
14274
14275 @menu
14276 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14277 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14278 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14279 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14280 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14281 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14282 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14283 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14284 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14285 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14286 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14287 * CRIS:: CRIS
14288 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14289 @end menu
14290
14291 @node ARM
14292 @subsection ARM
14293 @cindex ARM RDI
14294
14295 @table @code
14296 @kindex target rdi
14297 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14298 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14299 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14300 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14301
14302 @kindex target rdp
14303 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14304 ARM Demon monitor.
14305
14306 @end table
14307
14308 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14309
14310 @table @code
14311 @item set arm disassembler
14312 @kindex set arm
14313 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14314 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14315
14316 @item show arm disassembler
14317 @kindex show arm
14318 Show the current disassembly style.
14319
14320 @item set arm apcs32
14321 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14322 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14323
14324 @item show arm apcs32
14325 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14326
14327 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14328 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14329 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14330
14331 @table @code
14332 @item auto
14333 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14334 @item softfpa
14335 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14336 processors.
14337 @item fpa
14338 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14339 @item softvfp
14340 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14341 @item vfp
14342 VFP co-processor.
14343 @end table
14344
14345 @item show arm fpu
14346 Show the current type of the FPU.
14347
14348 @item set arm abi
14349 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14350
14351 @item show arm abi
14352 Show the currently used ABI.
14353
14354 @item set debug arm
14355 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14356 target support subsystem.
14357
14358 @item show debug arm
14359 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14360 @end table
14361
14362 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14363 using the RDI interface:
14364
14365 @table @code
14366 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14367 @kindex rdilogfile
14368 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14369 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14370 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14371 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14372 @file{rdi.log}.
14373
14374 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14375 @kindex rdilogenable
14376 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14377 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14378 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14379 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14380 are logged to a file.
14381
14382 @item set rdiromatzero
14383 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14384 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14385 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14386 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14387 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14388 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14389
14390 @item show rdiromatzero
14391 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14392 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14393
14394 @item set rdiheartbeat
14395 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14396 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14397 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14398 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14399 well as the Angel monitor.
14400
14401 @item show rdiheartbeat
14402 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14403 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14404 @end table
14405
14406
14407 @node M32R/D
14408 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14409
14410 @table @code
14411 @kindex target m32r
14412 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14413 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14414
14415 @kindex target m32rsdi
14416 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14417 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14418 @end table
14419
14420 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14421
14422 @table @code
14423 @item set download-path @var{path}
14424 @kindex set download-path
14425 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14426 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14427
14428 @item show download-path
14429 @kindex show download-path
14430 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14431
14432 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14433 @kindex set board-address
14434 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14435 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14436
14437 @item show board-address
14438 @kindex show board-address
14439 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14440
14441 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14442 @kindex set server-address
14443 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14444 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14445 host machine.
14446
14447 @item show server-address
14448 @kindex show server-address
14449 Display the IP address of the download server.
14450
14451 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14452 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14453 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14454 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14455 executable file is uploaded.
14456
14457 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14458 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14459 Test the @code{upload} command.
14460 @end table
14461
14462 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14463
14464 @table @code
14465 @item sdireset
14466 @kindex sdireset
14467 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14468 This command resets the SDI connection.
14469
14470 @item sdistatus
14471 @kindex sdistatus
14472 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14473
14474 @item debug_chaos
14475 @kindex debug_chaos
14476 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14477 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14478
14479 @item use_debug_dma
14480 @kindex use_debug_dma
14481 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14482
14483 @item use_mon_code
14484 @kindex use_mon_code
14485 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14486
14487 @item use_ib_break
14488 @kindex use_ib_break
14489 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14490
14491 @item use_dbt_break
14492 @kindex use_dbt_break
14493 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14494 @end table
14495
14496 @node M68K
14497 @subsection M68k
14498
14499 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14500 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14501
14502 @table @code
14503
14504 @kindex target dbug
14505 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14506 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14507
14508 @end table
14509
14510 @node MIPS Embedded
14511 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14512
14513 @cindex MIPS boards
14514 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14515 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14516 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14517
14518 @need 1000
14519 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14520
14521 @table @code
14522 @item target mips @var{port}
14523 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14524 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14525 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14526 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14527 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14528 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14529 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14530
14531 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14532 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14533 debugger:
14534
14535 @smallexample
14536 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14537 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14538 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14539 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14540 (@value{GDBP}) run
14541 @end smallexample
14542
14543 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14544 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14545 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14546 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14547 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14548
14549 @item target pmon @var{port}
14550 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14551 PMON ROM monitor.
14552
14553 @item target ddb @var{port}
14554 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14555 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14556
14557 @item target lsi @var{port}
14558 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14559 LSI variant of PMON.
14560
14561 @kindex target r3900
14562 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14563 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14564
14565 @kindex target array
14566 @item target array @var{dev}
14567 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14568
14569 @end table
14570
14571
14572 @noindent
14573 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14574
14575 @table @code
14576 @item set mipsfpu double
14577 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14578 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14579 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14580 @itemx show mipsfpu
14581 @kindex set mipsfpu
14582 @kindex show mipsfpu
14583 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14584 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14585 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14586 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14587 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14588 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14589 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14590 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14591 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14592 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14593 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14594 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14595 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14596
14597 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14598 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14599 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14600
14601 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14602 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14603
14604 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14605 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14606 @itemx show timeout
14607 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14608 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14609 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14610 @kindex set timeout
14611 @kindex show timeout
14612 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14613 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14614 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14615 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14616 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14617 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14618 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14619 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14620 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14621 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14622
14623 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14624 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14625 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14626 to run before stopping.
14627
14628 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14629 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14630 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14631 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14632 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14633 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14634
14635 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14636 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14637 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14638 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14639
14640 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14641 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14642 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14643 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14644 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14645 @table @asis
14646 @item pmon target
14647 @samp{PMON}
14648 @item ddb target
14649 @samp{NEC010}
14650 @item lsi target
14651 @samp{PMON>}
14652 @end table
14653
14654 @item show monitor-prompt
14655 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14656 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14657 remote monitor.
14658
14659 @item set monitor-warnings
14660 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14661 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14662 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14663 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14664 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14665
14666 @item show monitor-warnings
14667 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14668 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14669
14670 @item pmon @var{command}
14671 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14672 @cindex send PMON command
14673 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14674 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14675 @end table
14676
14677 @node OpenRISC 1000
14678 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14679 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14680
14681 @cindex or1k boards
14682 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14683 about platform and commands.
14684
14685 @table @code
14686
14687 @kindex target jtag
14688 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14689
14690 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14691 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14692 connected via parallel port to the board.
14693
14694 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14695
14696 @kindex or1ksim
14697 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14698 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14699 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14700
14701 @kindex info or1k spr
14702 @item info or1k spr
14703 Displays spr groups.
14704
14705 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14706 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14707 Displays register names in selected group.
14708
14709 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14710 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14711 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14712 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14713 Shows information about specified spr register.
14714
14715 @kindex spr
14716 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14717 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14718 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14719 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14720 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14721 @end table
14722
14723 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14724 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14725 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14726 triggers can be set using:
14727 @table @code
14728 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14729 Load effective address/data
14730 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14731 Store effective address/data
14732 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14733 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14734 @item $FETCH
14735 Fetch data
14736 @end table
14737
14738 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14739 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14740
14741 @code{htrace} commands:
14742 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14743 @table @code
14744 @kindex hwatch
14745 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14746 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
14747 or Data. For example:
14748
14749 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14750
14751 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14752
14753 @kindex htrace
14754 @item htrace info
14755 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14756
14757 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14758 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14759
14760 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14761 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14762
14763 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14764 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14765
14766 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14767 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14768 triggered.
14769
14770 @item htrace enable
14771 @itemx htrace disable
14772 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14773
14774 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14775 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14776
14777 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14778 will be written there.
14779
14780 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14781 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14782
14783 @item htrace mode continuous
14784 Set continuous trace mode.
14785
14786 @item htrace mode suspend
14787 Set suspend trace mode.
14788
14789 @end table
14790
14791 @node PowerPC
14792 @subsection PowerPC
14793
14794 @table @code
14795 @kindex target dink32
14796 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14797 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14798
14799 @kindex target ppcbug
14800 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14801 @kindex target ppcbug1
14802 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14803 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14804
14805 @kindex target sds
14806 @item target sds @var{dev}
14807 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14808 @end table
14809
14810 @cindex SDS protocol
14811 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
14812 by@value{GDBN}:
14813
14814 @table @code
14815 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14816 @kindex set sdstimeout
14817 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14818 default is 2 seconds.
14819
14820 @item show sdstimeout
14821 @kindex show sdstimeout
14822 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14823
14824 @item sds @var{command}
14825 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14826 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14827 @end table
14828
14829
14830 @node PA
14831 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14832
14833 @table @code
14834
14835 @kindex target op50n
14836 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14837 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14838
14839 @kindex target w89k
14840 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14841 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14842
14843 @end table
14844
14845 @node Sparclet
14846 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14847
14848 @cindex Sparclet
14849
14850 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14851 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14852 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14853 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14854 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14855
14856 @table @code
14857 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14858 @kindex remotetimeout
14859 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14860 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14861 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14862 @end table
14863
14864 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14865 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14866 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14867 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14868 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14869
14870 @smallexample
14871 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14872 @end smallexample
14873
14874 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14875
14876 @smallexample
14877 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14878 @end smallexample
14879
14880 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14881 Once you have set
14882 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14883 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14884 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14885
14886 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14887
14888 @smallexample
14889 (gdbslet)
14890 @end smallexample
14891
14892 @menu
14893 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14894 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14895 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14896 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14897 @end menu
14898
14899 @node Sparclet File
14900 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
14901
14902 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14903
14904 @smallexample
14905 (gdbslet) file prog
14906 @end smallexample
14907
14908 @need 1000
14909 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14910 @value{GDBN} locates
14911 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14912 path.
14913 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
14914 files will be searched as well.
14915 @value{GDBN} locates
14916 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14917 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
14918 If it fails
14919 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14920
14921 @smallexample
14922 prog: No such file or directory.
14923 @end smallexample
14924
14925 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14926 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14927 @code{target} command again.
14928
14929 @node Sparclet Connection
14930 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14931
14932 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14933 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14934
14935 @smallexample
14936 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14937 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14938 main () at ../prog.c:3
14939 @end smallexample
14940
14941 @need 750
14942 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14943
14944 @smallexample
14945 Connected to ttya.
14946 @end smallexample
14947
14948 @node Sparclet Download
14949 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
14950
14951 @cindex download to Sparclet
14952 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14953 you can use the @value{GDBN}
14954 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14955 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14956 command.
14957 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14958 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14959 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14960 of each of the file's sections.
14961 For instance, if the program
14962 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14963 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14964
14965 @smallexample
14966 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14967 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14968 @end smallexample
14969
14970 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14971 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14972 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14973
14974 @node Sparclet Execution
14975 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
14976
14977 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14978 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14979 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14980 manual for the list of commands.
14981
14982 @smallexample
14983 (gdbslet) b main
14984 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14985 (gdbslet) run
14986 Starting program: prog
14987 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
14988 3 char *symarg = 0;
14989 (gdbslet) step
14990 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
14991 (gdbslet)
14992 @end smallexample
14993
14994 @node Sparclite
14995 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14996
14997 @table @code
14998
14999 @kindex target sparclite
15000 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15001 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15002 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15003 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15004 remote protocol.
15005
15006 @end table
15007
15008 @node Z8000
15009 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15010
15011 @cindex Z8000
15012 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15013 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15014
15015 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15016 a Z8000 simulator.
15017
15018 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15019 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15020 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15021 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15022
15023 @table @code
15024 @item target sim @var{args}
15025 @kindex sim
15026 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15027 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15028 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15029 @end table
15030
15031 @noindent
15032 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15033 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15034 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15035 to run your program, and so on.
15036
15037 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15038 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15039 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15040
15041 @table @code
15042
15043 @item cycles
15044 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15045
15046 @item insts
15047 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15048
15049 @item time
15050 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15051
15052 @end table
15053
15054 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15055 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15056 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15057 simulated clock ticks.
15058
15059 @node AVR
15060 @subsection Atmel AVR
15061 @cindex AVR
15062
15063 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15064 following AVR-specific commands:
15065
15066 @table @code
15067 @item info io_registers
15068 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15069 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15070 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15071 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15072 @end table
15073
15074 @node CRIS
15075 @subsection CRIS
15076 @cindex CRIS
15077
15078 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15079 following CRIS-specific commands:
15080
15081 @table @code
15082 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15083 @cindex CRIS version
15084 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15085 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15086 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15087
15088 @item show cris-version
15089 Show the current CRIS version.
15090
15091 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15092 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15093 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15094 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15095 @code{R59}.
15096
15097 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15098 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15099
15100 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15101 @cindex CRIS mode
15102 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15103 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15104 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15105
15106 @item show cris-mode
15107 Show the current CRIS mode.
15108 @end table
15109
15110 @node Super-H
15111 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15112 @cindex Super-H
15113
15114 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15115 commands:
15116
15117 @table @code
15118 @item regs
15119 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15120 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15121 @end table
15122
15123
15124 @node Architectures
15125 @section Architectures
15126
15127 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15128 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15129
15130 @menu
15131 * i386::
15132 * A29K::
15133 * Alpha::
15134 * MIPS::
15135 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15136 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15137 @end menu
15138
15139 @node i386
15140 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15141
15142 @table @code
15143 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15144 @kindex set struct-convention
15145 @cindex struct return convention
15146 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15147 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15148 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15149 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15150 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15151 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15152 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15153 be returned in a register.
15154
15155 @item show struct-convention
15156 @kindex show struct-convention
15157 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15158 from functions.
15159 @end table
15160
15161 @node A29K
15162 @subsection A29K
15163
15164 @table @code
15165
15166 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15167 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15168 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15169 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15170 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15171 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15172 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15173 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15174 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15175 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15176 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15177 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15178 hexadecimal.
15179
15180 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15181 @item show rstack_high_address
15182 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15183 processors.
15184
15185 @end table
15186
15187 @node Alpha
15188 @subsection Alpha
15189
15190 See the following section.
15191
15192 @node MIPS
15193 @subsection MIPS
15194
15195 @cindex stack on Alpha
15196 @cindex stack on MIPS
15197 @cindex Alpha stack
15198 @cindex MIPS stack
15199 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15200 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15201 find the beginning of a function.
15202
15203 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15204 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15205 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15206 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15207 commands:
15208
15209 @table @code
15210 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15211 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15212 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15213 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15214 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15215 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15216 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15217 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15218
15219 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15220 Display the current limit.
15221 @end table
15222
15223 @noindent
15224 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15225 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15226
15227 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15228 programs:
15229
15230 @table @code
15231 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15232 @kindex set mips abi
15233 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15234 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15235 values of @var{arg} are:
15236
15237 @table @samp
15238 @item auto
15239 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15240 default).
15241 @item o32
15242 @item o64
15243 @item n32
15244 @item n64
15245 @item eabi32
15246 @item eabi64
15247 @item auto
15248 @end table
15249
15250 @item show mips abi
15251 @kindex show mips abi
15252 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15253
15254 @item set mipsfpu
15255 @itemx show mipsfpu
15256 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15257
15258 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15259 @kindex set mips mask-address
15260 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15261 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15262 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15263 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15264 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15265
15266 @item show mips mask-address
15267 @kindex show mips mask-address
15268 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15269 not.
15270
15271 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15272 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15273 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15274 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15275 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15276 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15277
15278 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15279 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15280 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15281
15282 @item set debug mips
15283 @kindex set debug mips
15284 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15285 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15286
15287 @item show debug mips
15288 @kindex show debug mips
15289 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15290 @end table
15291
15292
15293 @node HPPA
15294 @subsection HPPA
15295 @cindex HPPA support
15296
15297 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15298 following special commands:
15299
15300 @table @code
15301 @item set debug hppa
15302 @kindex set debug hppa
15303 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15304 messages are to be displayed.
15305
15306 @item show debug hppa
15307 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15308
15309 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15310 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15311 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15312 given @var{address}.
15313
15314 @end table
15315
15316
15317 @node SPU
15318 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15319 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15320 @cindex SPU
15321
15322 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15323 it provides the following special commands:
15324
15325 @table @code
15326 @item info spu event
15327 @kindex info spu
15328 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15329 and pending event status.
15330
15331 @item info spu signal
15332 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15333 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15334 notification channels.
15335
15336 @item info spu mailbox
15337 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15338 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15339 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15340
15341 @item info spu dma
15342 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15343 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15344 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15345
15346 @item info spu proxydma
15347 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15348 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15349 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15350
15351 @end table
15352
15353
15354 @node Controlling GDB
15355 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15356
15357 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15358 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15359 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15360 described here.
15361
15362 @menu
15363 * Prompt:: Prompt
15364 * Editing:: Command editing
15365 * Command History:: Command history
15366 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15367 * Numbers:: Numbers
15368 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15369 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15370 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15371 @end menu
15372
15373 @node Prompt
15374 @section Prompt
15375
15376 @cindex prompt
15377
15378 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15379 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15380 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15381 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15382 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15383 which one you are talking to.
15384
15385 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15386 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15387 or a prompt that does not.
15388
15389 @table @code
15390 @kindex set prompt
15391 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15392 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15393
15394 @kindex show prompt
15395 @item show prompt
15396 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15397 @end table
15398
15399 @node Editing
15400 @section Command Editing
15401 @cindex readline
15402 @cindex command line editing
15403
15404 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15405 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15406 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15407 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15408 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15409 debugging sessions.
15410
15411 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15412 command @code{set}.
15413
15414 @table @code
15415 @kindex set editing
15416 @cindex editing
15417 @item set editing
15418 @itemx set editing on
15419 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15420
15421 @item set editing off
15422 Disable command line editing.
15423
15424 @kindex show editing
15425 @item show editing
15426 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15427 @end table
15428
15429 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15430 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15431 encouraged to read that chapter.
15432
15433 @node Command History
15434 @section Command History
15435 @cindex command history
15436
15437 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15438 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15439 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15440 history facility.
15441
15442 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15443 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15444 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15445
15446 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15447 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15448 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15449 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15450 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15451 pressed on a line by itself.
15452
15453 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15454 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15455 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15456 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15457
15458 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15459 history.
15460
15461 @table @code
15462 @cindex history substitution
15463 @cindex history file
15464 @kindex set history filename
15465 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15466 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15467 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15468 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15469 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15470 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15471 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15472 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15473 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15474 is not set.
15475
15476 @cindex save command history
15477 @kindex set history save
15478 @item set history save
15479 @itemx set history save on
15480 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15481 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15482
15483 @item set history save off
15484 Stop recording command history in a file.
15485
15486 @cindex history size
15487 @kindex set history size
15488 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15489 @item set history size @var{size}
15490 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15491 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15492 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15493 @end table
15494
15495 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15496 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15497
15498 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15499 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15500 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15501 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15502 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15503 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15504 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15505 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15506
15507 The commands to control history expansion are:
15508
15509 @table @code
15510 @item set history expansion on
15511 @itemx set history expansion
15512 @kindex set history expansion
15513 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15514
15515 @item set history expansion off
15516 Disable history expansion.
15517
15518 @c @group
15519 @kindex show history
15520 @item show history
15521 @itemx show history filename
15522 @itemx show history save
15523 @itemx show history size
15524 @itemx show history expansion
15525 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15526 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15527 @c @end group
15528 @end table
15529
15530 @table @code
15531 @kindex show commands
15532 @cindex show last commands
15533 @cindex display command history
15534 @item show commands
15535 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15536
15537 @item show commands @var{n}
15538 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15539
15540 @item show commands +
15541 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15542 @end table
15543
15544 @node Screen Size
15545 @section Screen Size
15546 @cindex size of screen
15547 @cindex pauses in output
15548
15549 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15550 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15551 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15552 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15553 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15554 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15555 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15556 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15557
15558 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15559 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15560 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15561 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15562 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15563 width} commands:
15564
15565 @table @code
15566 @kindex set height
15567 @kindex set width
15568 @kindex show width
15569 @kindex show height
15570 @item set height @var{lpp}
15571 @itemx show height
15572 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15573 @itemx show width
15574 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15575 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15576 commands display the current settings.
15577
15578 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15579 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15580 file or to an editor buffer.
15581
15582 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15583 from wrapping its output.
15584
15585 @item set pagination on
15586 @itemx set pagination off
15587 @kindex set pagination
15588 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15589 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15590
15591 @item show pagination
15592 @kindex show pagination
15593 Show the current pagination mode.
15594 @end table
15595
15596 @node Numbers
15597 @section Numbers
15598 @cindex number representation
15599 @cindex entering numbers
15600
15601 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15602 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15603 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15604 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15605 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15606 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15607 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15608 both input and output with the commands described below.
15609
15610 @table @code
15611 @kindex set input-radix
15612 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15613 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15614 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15615 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15616 example, any of
15617
15618 @smallexample
15619 set input-radix 012
15620 set input-radix 10.
15621 set input-radix 0xa
15622 @end smallexample
15623
15624 @noindent
15625 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15626 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15627 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15628 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15629 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15630 change the radix.
15631
15632 @kindex set output-radix
15633 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15634 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15635 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15636 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15637
15638 @kindex show input-radix
15639 @item show input-radix
15640 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15641
15642 @kindex show output-radix
15643 @item show output-radix
15644 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15645
15646 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15647 @itemx show radix
15648 @kindex set radix
15649 @kindex show radix
15650 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15651 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15652 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15653 default value of 10.
15654
15655 @end table
15656
15657 @node ABI
15658 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15659
15660 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15661 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15662 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15663 current ABI.
15664
15665 @cindex OS ABI
15666 @kindex set osabi
15667 @kindex show osabi
15668
15669 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15670 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15671 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15672 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15673 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15674 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15675 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15676 platform provides.
15677
15678 @table @code
15679 @item show osabi
15680 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15681
15682 @item set osabi
15683 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15684
15685 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15686 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15687 @end table
15688
15689 @cindex float promotion
15690
15691 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15692 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15693 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15694 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15695 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15696 @code{double} and then passed.
15697
15698 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15699 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15700 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15701
15702 @table @code
15703 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15704 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15705 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15706 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15707 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15708
15709 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15710 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15711 functions.
15712
15713 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15714 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15715 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15716 @end table
15717
15718 @kindex set cp-abi
15719 @kindex show cp-abi
15720 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15721 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15722 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15723 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15724 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15725 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15726 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15727 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15728 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15729 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15730 ``auto''.
15731
15732 @table @code
15733 @item show cp-abi
15734 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15735
15736 @item set cp-abi
15737 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15738
15739 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15740 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15741 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15742 @end table
15743
15744 @node Messages/Warnings
15745 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
15746
15747 @cindex verbose operation
15748 @cindex optional warnings
15749 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15750 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15751 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15752 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15753
15754 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15755 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15756 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
15757
15758 @table @code
15759 @kindex set verbose
15760 @item set verbose on
15761 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15762
15763 @item set verbose off
15764 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15765
15766 @kindex show verbose
15767 @item show verbose
15768 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15769 @end table
15770
15771 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15772 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15773 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
15774 Symbol Files}).
15775
15776 @table @code
15777
15778 @kindex set complaints
15779 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15780 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15781 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15782 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15783 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15784
15785 @kindex show complaints
15786 @item show complaints
15787 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15788
15789 @end table
15790
15791 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15792 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15793 you try to run a program which is already running:
15794
15795 @smallexample
15796 (@value{GDBP}) run
15797 The program being debugged has been started already.
15798 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15799 @end smallexample
15800
15801 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15802 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15803
15804 @table @code
15805
15806 @kindex set confirm
15807 @cindex flinching
15808 @cindex confirmation
15809 @cindex stupid questions
15810 @item set confirm off
15811 Disables confirmation requests.
15812
15813 @item set confirm on
15814 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15815
15816 @kindex show confirm
15817 @item show confirm
15818 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15819
15820 @end table
15821
15822 @cindex command tracing
15823 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
15824 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
15825 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
15826 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
15827
15828 @table @code
15829 @kindex set trace-commands
15830 @cindex command scripts, debugging
15831 @item set trace-commands on
15832 Enable command tracing.
15833 @item set trace-commands off
15834 Disable command tracing.
15835 @item show trace-commands
15836 Display the current state of command tracing.
15837 @end table
15838
15839 @node Debugging Output
15840 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
15841 @cindex optional debugging messages
15842
15843 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15844 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15845 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15846 section documents those commands.
15847
15848 @table @code
15849 @kindex set exec-done-display
15850 @item set exec-done-display
15851 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15852 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15853 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15854 @kindex show exec-done-display
15855 @item show exec-done-display
15856 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15857 notification.
15858 @kindex set debug
15859 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15860 @cindex architecture debugging info
15861 @item set debug arch
15862 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15863 @kindex show debug
15864 @item show debug arch
15865 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15866 @item set debug aix-thread
15867 @cindex AIX threads
15868 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15869 module.
15870 @item show debug aix-thread
15871 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15872 @item set debug event
15873 @cindex event debugging info
15874 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15875 default is off.
15876 @item show debug event
15877 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15878 info.
15879 @item set debug expression
15880 @cindex expression debugging info
15881 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15882 expression parsing. The default is off.
15883 @item show debug expression
15884 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15885 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15886 @item set debug frame
15887 @cindex frame debugging info
15888 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15889 default is off.
15890 @item show debug frame
15891 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15892 info.
15893 @item set debug infrun
15894 @cindex inferior debugging info
15895 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15896 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15897 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15898 @item show debug infrun
15899 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15900 @item set debug lin-lwp
15901 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15902 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
15903 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15904 @item show debug lin-lwp
15905 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15906 @item set debug observer
15907 @cindex observer debugging info
15908 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15909 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15910 @item show debug observer
15911 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15912 @item set debug overload
15913 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15914 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15915 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15916 is off.
15917 @item show debug overload
15918 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15919 debugging info.
15920 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15921 @cindex serial connections, debugging
15922 @cindex debug remote protocol
15923 @cindex remote protocol debugging
15924 @cindex display remote packets
15925 @item set debug remote
15926 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15927 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15928 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15929 @item show debug remote
15930 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15931 @item set debug serial
15932 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15933 default is off.
15934 @item show debug serial
15935 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15936 info.
15937 @item set debug solib-frv
15938 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15939 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15940 @item show debug solib-frv
15941 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15942 messages.
15943 @item set debug target
15944 @cindex target debugging info
15945 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15946 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15947 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15948 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15949 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15950 @item show debug target
15951 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15952 info.
15953 @item set debugvarobj
15954 @cindex variable object debugging info
15955 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15956 info. The default is off.
15957 @item show debugvarobj
15958 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15959 debugging info.
15960 @item set debug xml
15961 @cindex XML parser debugging
15962 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
15963 @item show debug xml
15964 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
15965 @end table
15966
15967 @node Sequences
15968 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15969
15970 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15971 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15972 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15973 files.
15974
15975 @menu
15976 * Define:: How to define your own commands
15977 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
15978 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
15979 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
15980 @end menu
15981
15982 @node Define
15983 @section User-defined Commands
15984
15985 @cindex user-defined command
15986 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
15987 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15988 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
15989 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
15990 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
15991 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
15992
15993 @smallexample
15994 define adder
15995 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15996 end
15997 @end smallexample
15998
15999 @noindent
16000 To execute the command use:
16001
16002 @smallexample
16003 adder 1 2 3
16004 @end smallexample
16005
16006 @noindent
16007 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16008 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16009 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16010 functions calls.
16011
16012 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16013 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16014 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16015 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16016
16017 @smallexample
16018 define adder
16019 if $argc == 2
16020 print $arg0 + $arg1
16021 end
16022 if $argc == 3
16023 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16024 end
16025 end
16026 @end smallexample
16027
16028 @table @code
16029
16030 @kindex define
16031 @item define @var{commandname}
16032 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16033 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16034
16035 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16036 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16037 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16038
16039 @kindex document
16040 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16041 @item document @var{commandname}
16042 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16043 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16044 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16045 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16046 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16047 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16048
16049 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16050 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16051 does not change the documentation.
16052
16053 @kindex dont-repeat
16054 @cindex don't repeat command
16055 @item dont-repeat
16056 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16057 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16058 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16059
16060 @kindex help user-defined
16061 @item help user-defined
16062 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16063 (if any) for each.
16064
16065 @kindex show user
16066 @item show user
16067 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16068 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16069 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16070 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16071
16072 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16073 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16074 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16075 @item show max-user-call-depth
16076 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16077 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16078 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16079 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16080 @end table
16081
16082 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16083 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16084
16085 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16086 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16087 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16088
16089 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16090 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16091 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16092 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16093
16094 @node Hooks
16095 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16096 @cindex command hooks
16097 @cindex hooks, for commands
16098 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16099
16100 @kindex hook
16101 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16102 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16103 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16104 before that command.
16105
16106 @cindex hooks, post-command
16107 @kindex hookpost
16108 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16109 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16110 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16111 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16112 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16113
16114 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16115 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16116
16117 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16118 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16119
16120 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16121 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16122 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16123 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16124 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16125
16126 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16127 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16128 you could define:
16129
16130 @smallexample
16131 define hook-stop
16132 handle SIGALRM nopass
16133 end
16134
16135 define hook-run
16136 handle SIGALRM pass
16137 end
16138
16139 define hook-continue
16140 handle SIGALRM pass
16141 end
16142 @end smallexample
16143
16144 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16145 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16146 you could define:
16147
16148 @smallexample
16149 define hook-echo
16150 echo <<<---
16151 end
16152
16153 define hookpost-echo
16154 echo --->>>\n
16155 end
16156
16157 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16158 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16159 (@value{GDBP})
16160
16161 @end smallexample
16162
16163 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16164 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16165 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16166 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16167 @c or not?
16168 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16169 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16170 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16171
16172 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16173 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16174
16175 @node Command Files
16176 @section Command Files
16177
16178 @cindex command files
16179 @cindex scripting commands
16180 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16181 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16182 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16183 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16184 terminal.
16185
16186 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16187 command:
16188
16189 @table @code
16190 @kindex source
16191 @cindex execute commands from a file
16192 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16193 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16194 @end table
16195
16196 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16197 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16198 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16199 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16200 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16201
16202 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16203 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16204
16205 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16206 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16207 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16208
16209 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16210 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16211 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16212 when called from command files.
16213
16214 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16215 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16216 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16217 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16218 the next command.
16219
16220 @smallexample
16221 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16222 @end smallexample
16223
16224 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16225 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16226 would be directed to @file{log}.
16227
16228 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16229 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16230 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16231 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16232 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16233 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16234 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16235 conditionally, etc.
16236
16237 @table @code
16238 @kindex if
16239 @kindex else
16240 @item if
16241 @itemx else
16242 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16243 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16244 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16245 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16246 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16247 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16248 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16249
16250 @kindex while
16251 @item while
16252 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16253 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16254 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16255 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16256 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16257 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16258
16259 @kindex loop_break
16260 @item loop_break
16261 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16262 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16263 line.
16264
16265 @kindex loop_continue
16266 @item loop_continue
16267 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16268 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16269 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16270 the controlling expression.
16271
16272 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16273 @item end
16274 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16275 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16276 @end table
16277
16278
16279 @node Output
16280 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16281
16282 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16283 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16284 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16285 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16286 want.
16287
16288 @table @code
16289 @kindex echo
16290 @item echo @var{text}
16291 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16292 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16293 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16294 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16295 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16296 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16297 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16298 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16299 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16300 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16301 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16302
16303 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16304 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16305
16306 @smallexample
16307 echo This is some text\n\
16308 which is continued\n\
16309 onto several lines.\n
16310 @end smallexample
16311
16312 produces the same output as
16313
16314 @smallexample
16315 echo This is some text\n
16316 echo which is continued\n
16317 echo onto several lines.\n
16318 @end smallexample
16319
16320 @kindex output
16321 @item output @var{expression}
16322 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16323 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16324 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16325 on expressions.
16326
16327 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16328 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16329 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16330 Formats}, for more information.
16331
16332 @kindex printf
16333 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16334 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16335 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16336 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16337 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16338 subroutine
16339 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16340 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16341 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16342 @c supported.
16343
16344 @smallexample
16345 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16346 @end smallexample
16347
16348 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16349
16350 @smallexample
16351 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16352 @end smallexample
16353
16354 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16355 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16356 letter.
16357 @end table
16358
16359 @node Interpreters
16360 @chapter Command Interpreters
16361 @cindex command interpreters
16362
16363 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16364 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16365 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16366
16367 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16368 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16369 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16370 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16371
16372 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16373 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16374 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16375 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16376
16377 @table @code
16378 @item console
16379 @cindex console interpreter
16380 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16381 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16382 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16383
16384 @item mi
16385 @cindex mi interpreter
16386 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16387 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16388 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16389 Interface}.
16390
16391 @item mi2
16392 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16393 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16394
16395 @item mi1
16396 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16397 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16398
16399 @end table
16400
16401 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16402 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16403 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16404 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16405 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16406 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16407 the IDE inoperable!
16408
16409 @kindex interpreter-exec
16410 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16411 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16412 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16413 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16417 @end smallexample
16418
16419 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16420 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16421
16422 @node TUI
16423 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16424 @cindex TUI
16425 @cindex Text User Interface
16426
16427 @menu
16428 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16429 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16430 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16431 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16432 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16433 @end menu
16434
16435 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16436 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16437 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16438 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16439 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16440 is available.
16441
16442 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16443 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16444 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16445 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16446 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16447 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16448
16449 @node TUI Overview
16450 @section TUI Overview
16451
16452 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16453
16454 @table @emph
16455 @item command
16456 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16457 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16458 managed using readline.
16459
16460 @item source
16461 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16462 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16463
16464 @item assembly
16465 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16466
16467 @item register
16468 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16469 when their values change.
16470 @end table
16471
16472 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16473 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16474 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16475 indicates the breakpoint type:
16476
16477 @table @code
16478 @item B
16479 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16480
16481 @item b
16482 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16483
16484 @item H
16485 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16486
16487 @item h
16488 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16489 @end table
16490
16491 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16492
16493 @table @code
16494 @item +
16495 Breakpoint is enabled.
16496
16497 @item -
16498 Breakpoint is disabled.
16499 @end table
16500
16501 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16502 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16503 changes.
16504
16505 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16506 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16507 layouts:
16508
16509 @itemize @bullet
16510 @item
16511 source only,
16512
16513 @item
16514 assembly only,
16515
16516 @item
16517 source and assembly,
16518
16519 @item
16520 source and registers, or
16521
16522 @item
16523 assembly and registers.
16524 @end itemize
16525
16526 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16527
16528 @table @emph
16529 @item target
16530 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16531 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16532
16533 @item process
16534 Gives the current process or thread number.
16535 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16536
16537 @item function
16538 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16539 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16540 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16541 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16542
16543 @item line
16544 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16545 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16546
16547 @item pc
16548 Indicates the current program counter address.
16549 @end table
16550
16551 @node TUI Keys
16552 @section TUI Key Bindings
16553 @cindex TUI key bindings
16554
16555 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16556 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16557 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16558
16559 @table @kbd
16560 @kindex C-x C-a
16561 @item C-x C-a
16562 @kindex C-x a
16563 @itemx C-x a
16564 @kindex C-x A
16565 @itemx C-x A
16566 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16567 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16568 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16569 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16570 The screen is then refreshed.
16571
16572 @kindex C-x 1
16573 @item C-x 1
16574 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16575 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16576 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16577
16578 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16579
16580 @kindex C-x 2
16581 @item C-x 2
16582 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16583 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16584 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16585 previous layout and the new one.
16586
16587 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16588
16589 @kindex C-x o
16590 @item C-x o
16591 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16592 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
16593 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16594
16595 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16596
16597 @kindex C-x s
16598 @item C-x s
16599 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
16600 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16601 @end table
16602
16603 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
16604
16605 @table @asis
16606 @kindex PgUp
16607 @item @key{PgUp}
16608 Scroll the active window one page up.
16609
16610 @kindex PgDn
16611 @item @key{PgDn}
16612 Scroll the active window one page down.
16613
16614 @kindex Up
16615 @item @key{Up}
16616 Scroll the active window one line up.
16617
16618 @kindex Down
16619 @item @key{Down}
16620 Scroll the active window one line down.
16621
16622 @kindex Left
16623 @item @key{Left}
16624 Scroll the active window one column left.
16625
16626 @kindex Right
16627 @item @key{Right}
16628 Scroll the active window one column right.
16629
16630 @kindex C-L
16631 @item @kbd{C-L}
16632 Refresh the screen.
16633 @end table
16634
16635 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
16636 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
16637 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
16638 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
16639 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
16640
16641 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16642 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16643 @cindex TUI single key mode
16644
16645 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
16646 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
16647 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
16648
16649 @table @kbd
16650 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16651 @item c
16652 continue
16653
16654 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16655 @item d
16656 down
16657
16658 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16659 @item f
16660 finish
16661
16662 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16663 @item n
16664 next
16665
16666 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16667 @item q
16668 exit the SingleKey mode.
16669
16670 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16671 @item r
16672 run
16673
16674 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16675 @item s
16676 step
16677
16678 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16679 @item u
16680 up
16681
16682 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16683 @item v
16684 info locals
16685
16686 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16687 @item w
16688 where
16689 @end table
16690
16691 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16692 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16693 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16694 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16695 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16696 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16697
16698
16699 @node TUI Commands
16700 @section TUI-specific Commands
16701 @cindex TUI commands
16702
16703 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16704 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
16705 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
16706 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
16707
16708 @table @code
16709 @item info win
16710 @kindex info win
16711 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16712
16713 @item layout next
16714 @kindex layout
16715 Display the next layout.
16716
16717 @item layout prev
16718 Display the previous layout.
16719
16720 @item layout src
16721 Display the source window only.
16722
16723 @item layout asm
16724 Display the assembly window only.
16725
16726 @item layout split
16727 Display the source and assembly window.
16728
16729 @item layout regs
16730 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16731
16732 @item focus next
16733 @kindex focus
16734 Make the next window active for scrolling.
16735
16736 @item focus prev
16737 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
16738
16739 @item focus src
16740 Make the source window active for scrolling.
16741
16742 @item focus asm
16743 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
16744
16745 @item focus regs
16746 Make the register window active for scrolling.
16747
16748 @item focus cmd
16749 Make the command window active for scrolling.
16750
16751 @item refresh
16752 @kindex refresh
16753 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
16754
16755 @item tui reg float
16756 @kindex tui reg
16757 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16758
16759 @item tui reg general
16760 Show the general registers in the register window.
16761
16762 @item tui reg next
16763 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16764 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16765 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16766 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16767
16768 @item tui reg system
16769 Show the system registers in the register window.
16770
16771 @item update
16772 @kindex update
16773 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16774
16775 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16776 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16777 @kindex winheight
16778 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16779 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16780 decrease it.
16781
16782 @item tabset @var{nchars}
16783 @kindex tabset
16784 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16785 @end table
16786
16787 @node TUI Configuration
16788 @section TUI Configuration Variables
16789 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16790
16791 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
16792
16793 @table @code
16794 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16795 @kindex set tui border-kind
16796 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16797 The possible values are the following:
16798 @table @code
16799 @item space
16800 Use a space character to draw the border.
16801
16802 @item ascii
16803 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
16804
16805 @item acs
16806 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16807 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16808 @end table
16809
16810 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16811 @kindex set tui border-mode
16812 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16813 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16814 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
16815 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16816 @table @code
16817 @item normal
16818 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16819
16820 @item standout
16821 Use standout mode.
16822
16823 @item reverse
16824 Use reverse video mode.
16825
16826 @item half
16827 Use half bright mode.
16828
16829 @item half-standout
16830 Use half bright and standout mode.
16831
16832 @item bold
16833 Use extra bright or bold mode.
16834
16835 @item bold-standout
16836 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16837 @end table
16838 @end table
16839
16840 @node Emacs
16841 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16842
16843 @cindex Emacs
16844 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16845 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16846 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16847 @value{GDBN}.
16848
16849 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16850 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16851 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16852 created Emacs buffer.
16853 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16854
16855 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16856 things:
16857
16858 @itemize @bullet
16859 @item
16860 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
16861 the GUD buffer.
16862
16863 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16864 and output done by the program you are debugging.
16865
16866 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16867 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16868 in this way.
16869
16870 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16871 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16872 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16873 stop.
16874
16875 @item
16876 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16877
16878 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16879 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16880 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16881 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16882 and the source.
16883
16884 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16885 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16886 @end itemize
16887
16888 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
16889 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
16890 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
16891 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
16892
16893 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16894 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16895 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16896 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16897 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16898 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16899 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16900 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16901 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16902
16903 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16904 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
16905 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
16906 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16907
16908 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16909 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16910 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16911 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16912 one you want.
16913
16914 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16915 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16916
16917 @table @kbd
16918 @item C-h m
16919 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
16920
16921 @item C-c C-s
16922 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16923 update the display window to show the current file and location.
16924
16925 @item C-c C-n
16926 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16927 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16928 to show the current file and location.
16929
16930 @item C-c C-i
16931 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16932 display window accordingly.
16933
16934 @item C-c C-f
16935 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16936 @code{finish} command.
16937
16938 @item C-c C-r
16939 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16940 command.
16941
16942 @item C-c <
16943 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16944 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16945 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16946
16947 @item C-c >
16948 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16949 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16950 @end table
16951
16952 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
16953 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16954
16955 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
16956 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
16957 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
16958 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
16959 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
16960 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
16961 speedbar displays watch expressions.
16962
16963 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16964 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16965 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16966 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16967 frame.
16968
16969 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16970 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16971 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16972 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16973 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16974 to correspond properly with the code.
16975
16976 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
16977 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
16978 Emacs Manual}).
16979
16980 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
16981 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
16982 @ignore
16983 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
16984 @kindex Epoch
16985 @kindex inspect
16986
16987 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
16988 called the @code{epoch}
16989 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
16990 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
16991 each value is printed in its own window.
16992 @end ignore
16993
16994
16995 @node GDB/MI
16996 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
16997
16998 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
16999
17000 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17001 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17002 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17003 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17004 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17005 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17006
17007 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17008 in the form of a reference manual.
17009
17010 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17011 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17012 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17013
17014 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17015
17016 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17017 This chapter uses the following notation:
17018
17019 @itemize @bullet
17020 @item
17021 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17022
17023 @item
17024 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17025 it may or may not be given.
17026
17027 @item
17028 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17029 may repeat zero or more times.
17030
17031 @item
17032 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17033 may repeat one or more times.
17034
17035 @item
17036 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17037 @end itemize
17038
17039 @ignore
17040 @heading Dependencies
17041 @end ignore
17042
17043 @menu
17044 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17045 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17046 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17047 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17048 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17049 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17050 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17051 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17052 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17053 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17054 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17055 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17056 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17057 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17058 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17059 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17060 @ignore
17061 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17062 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17063 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17064 @end ignore
17065 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17066 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17067 @end menu
17068
17069 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17070 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17071 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17072
17073 @menu
17074 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17075 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17076 @end menu
17077
17078 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17079 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17080
17081 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17082 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17083 @table @code
17084 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17085 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17086
17087 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17088 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17089 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17090
17091 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17092 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17093 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17094
17095 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17096 "any sequence of digits"
17097
17098 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17099 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17100
17101 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17102 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17103
17104 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17105 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17106
17107 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17108 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17109 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17110
17111 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17112 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17113
17114 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17115 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17116 @end table
17117
17118 @noindent
17119 Notes:
17120
17121 @itemize @bullet
17122 @item
17123 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17124 output is described below.
17125
17126 @item
17127 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17128 finishes.
17129
17130 @item
17131 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17132 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17133 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17134 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17135 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17136 @end itemize
17137
17138 Pragmatics:
17139
17140 @itemize @bullet
17141 @item
17142 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17143
17144 @item
17145 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17146 @end itemize
17147
17148 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17149 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17150
17151 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17152 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17153 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17154 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17155 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17156 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17157
17158 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17159 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17160 @var{token}.
17161
17162 @table @code
17163 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17164 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17165
17166 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17167 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17168
17169 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17170 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17171
17172 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17173 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17174
17175 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17176 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17177
17178 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17179 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17180
17181 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17182 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17183
17184 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17185 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17186
17187 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17188 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17189
17190 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17191 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17192 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17193
17194 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17195 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17196
17197 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17198 @code{ @var{string} }
17199
17200 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17201 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17202
17203 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17204 @code{@var{c-string}}
17205
17206 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17207 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17208
17209 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17210 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17211 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17212
17213 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17214 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17215
17216 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17217 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17218
17219 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17220 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17221
17222 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17223 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17224
17225 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17226 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17227
17228 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17229 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17230 @end table
17231
17232 @noindent
17233 Notes:
17234
17235 @itemize @bullet
17236 @item
17237 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17238
17239 @item
17240 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17241 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17242 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17243 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17244
17245 @item
17246 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17247 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17248 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17249 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17250
17251 @item
17252 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17253 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17254 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17255 @samp{*}.
17256
17257 @item
17258 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17259 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17260 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17261 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17262
17263 @item
17264 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17265 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17266 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17267 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17268
17269 @item
17270 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17271 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17272 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17273
17274 @item
17275 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17276 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17277 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17278 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17279
17280 @item
17281 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17282 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17283 @var{values}.
17284
17285
17286 @end itemize
17287
17288 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17289 details about the various output records.
17290
17291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17292 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17294
17295 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17296 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17297
17298 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17299 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17300 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17301 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17302 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17303 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17304
17305 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17306 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17307 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17308
17309 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17310 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17311 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17312 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17313
17314 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17315 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17316
17317 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17318 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17319 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17320 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17321 might change.
17322
17323 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17324 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17325 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17326 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17327
17328 @itemize @bullet
17329 @item
17330 New MI commands may be added.
17331
17332 @item
17333 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17334
17335 @item
17336 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17337 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17338
17339 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17340 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17341
17342 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17343 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17344 @end itemize
17345
17346 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17347 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17348 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17349 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17350 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17351
17352 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17353 @c version?
17354
17355 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17356 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17357 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17358 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17359 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17360 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17361 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17362 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17363 @cindex mailing lists
17364
17365 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17366 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17367 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17368
17369 @menu
17370 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17371 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17372 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17373 @end menu
17374
17375 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17376 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17377
17378 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17379 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17380 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17381 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17382
17383 @table @code
17384 @findex ^done
17385 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17386 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17387 values.
17388
17389 @item "^running"
17390 @findex ^running
17391 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17392 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17393 running.
17394
17395 @item "^connected"
17396 @findex ^connected
17397 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17398
17399 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17400 @findex ^error
17401 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17402 error message.
17403
17404 @item "^exit"
17405 @findex ^exit
17406 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17407
17408 @end table
17409
17410 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17411 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17412
17413 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17414 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17415 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17416 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17417 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17418
17419 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17420 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17421 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17422 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17423 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17424
17425 @table @code
17426 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17427 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17428 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17429
17430 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17431 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17432 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17433 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17434
17435 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17436 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17437 internals.
17438 @end table
17439
17440 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17441 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17442
17443 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17444 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17445 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17446 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17447 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17448 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17449
17450 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17451 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17452
17453 @table @code
17454 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17455 @end table
17456
17457 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17458
17459 @table @code
17460 @item breakpoint-hit
17461 A breakpoint was reached.
17462 @item watchpoint-trigger
17463 A watchpoint was triggered.
17464 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17465 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17466 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17467 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17468 @item function-finished
17469 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17470 @item location-reached
17471 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17472 @item watchpoint-scope
17473 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17474 @item end-stepping-range
17475 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17476 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17477 @item exited-signalled
17478 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17479 @item exited
17480 The inferior exited.
17481 @item exited-normally
17482 The inferior exited normally.
17483 @item signal-received
17484 A signal was received by the inferior.
17485 @end table
17486
17487
17488 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17489 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17490 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17491 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17492
17493 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17494 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17495 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17496 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17497
17498 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17499 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17500
17501 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17502
17503 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17504 information of the breakpoint.
17505
17506 @smallexample
17507 -> -break-insert main
17508 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17509 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17510 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17511 <- (gdb)
17512 @end smallexample
17513
17514 @subheading Program Execution
17515
17516 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17517 reason that execution stopped.
17518
17519 @smallexample
17520 -> -exec-run
17521 <- ^running
17522 <- (gdb)
17523 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17524 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17525 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17526 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17527 <- (gdb)
17528 -> -exec-continue
17529 <- ^running
17530 <- (gdb)
17531 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17532 <- (gdb)
17533 @end smallexample
17534
17535 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17536
17537 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17538
17539 @smallexample
17540 -> (gdb)
17541 <- -gdb-exit
17542 <- ^exit
17543 @end smallexample
17544
17545 @subheading A Bad Command
17546
17547 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17548
17549 @smallexample
17550 -> -rubbish
17551 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17552 <- (gdb)
17553 @end smallexample
17554
17555
17556 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17557 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17558 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17559
17560 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17561 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17562
17563 @subheading Motivation
17564
17565 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17566
17567 @subheading Introduction
17568
17569 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17570
17571 @subheading Commands
17572
17573 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17574
17575 @subsubheading Synopsis
17576
17577 @smallexample
17578 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17579 @end smallexample
17580
17581 @subsubheading Result
17582
17583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17584
17585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17586
17587 @subsubheading Example
17588
17589 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17590 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17591
17592
17593 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17594 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17595 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17596
17597 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17598 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17599 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17600 breakpoints.
17601
17602 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17603 @findex -break-after
17604
17605 @subsubheading Synopsis
17606
17607 @smallexample
17608 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17609 @end smallexample
17610
17611 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17612 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17613 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17614 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17615
17616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17617
17618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17619
17620 @subsubheading Example
17621
17622 @smallexample
17623 (gdb)
17624 -break-insert main
17625 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17626 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17627 (gdb)
17628 -break-after 1 3
17629 ~
17630 ^done
17631 (gdb)
17632 -break-list
17633 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17634 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17635 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17636 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17637 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17638 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17639 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17640 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17641 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17642 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17643 (gdb)
17644 @end smallexample
17645
17646 @ignore
17647 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17648 @findex -break-catch
17649
17650 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17651 @findex -break-commands
17652 @end ignore
17653
17654
17655 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17656 @findex -break-condition
17657
17658 @subsubheading Synopsis
17659
17660 @smallexample
17661 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17662 @end smallexample
17663
17664 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17665 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17666 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17667 command below).
17668
17669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17670
17671 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17672
17673 @subsubheading Example
17674
17675 @smallexample
17676 (gdb)
17677 -break-condition 1 1
17678 ^done
17679 (gdb)
17680 -break-list
17681 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17682 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17683 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17684 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17685 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17686 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17687 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17688 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17689 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17690 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17691 (gdb)
17692 @end smallexample
17693
17694 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17695 @findex -break-delete
17696
17697 @subsubheading Synopsis
17698
17699 @smallexample
17700 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17701 @end smallexample
17702
17703 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17704 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17705
17706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17707
17708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17709
17710 @subsubheading Example
17711
17712 @smallexample
17713 (gdb)
17714 -break-delete 1
17715 ^done
17716 (gdb)
17717 -break-list
17718 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17719 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17720 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17721 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17722 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17723 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17724 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17725 body=[]@}
17726 (gdb)
17727 @end smallexample
17728
17729 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17730 @findex -break-disable
17731
17732 @subsubheading Synopsis
17733
17734 @smallexample
17735 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17736 @end smallexample
17737
17738 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17739 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17740
17741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17742
17743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17744
17745 @subsubheading Example
17746
17747 @smallexample
17748 (gdb)
17749 -break-disable 2
17750 ^done
17751 (gdb)
17752 -break-list
17753 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17754 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17755 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17756 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17757 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17758 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17759 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17760 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17761 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17762 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17763 (gdb)
17764 @end smallexample
17765
17766 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17767 @findex -break-enable
17768
17769 @subsubheading Synopsis
17770
17771 @smallexample
17772 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17773 @end smallexample
17774
17775 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17776
17777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17778
17779 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17780
17781 @subsubheading Example
17782
17783 @smallexample
17784 (gdb)
17785 -break-enable 2
17786 ^done
17787 (gdb)
17788 -break-list
17789 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17790 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17791 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17792 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17793 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17794 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17795 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17796 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17797 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17798 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17799 (gdb)
17800 @end smallexample
17801
17802 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17803 @findex -break-info
17804
17805 @subsubheading Synopsis
17806
17807 @smallexample
17808 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17809 @end smallexample
17810
17811 @c REDUNDANT???
17812 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17813
17814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17815
17816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17817
17818 @subsubheading Example
17819 N.A.
17820
17821 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17822 @findex -break-insert
17823
17824 @subsubheading Synopsis
17825
17826 @smallexample
17827 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17828 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17829 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17830 @end smallexample
17831
17832 @noindent
17833 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17834
17835 @itemize @bullet
17836 @item function
17837 @c @item +offset
17838 @c @item -offset
17839 @c @item linenum
17840 @item filename:linenum
17841 @item filename:function
17842 @item *address
17843 @end itemize
17844
17845 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17846
17847 @table @samp
17848 @item -t
17849 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
17850 @item -h
17851 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17852 @item -c @var{condition}
17853 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17854 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
17855 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17856 @item -r
17857 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17858 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17859 expressions.
17860 @end table
17861
17862 @subsubheading Result
17863
17864 The result is in the form:
17865
17866 @smallexample
17867 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
17868 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
17869 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
17870 times="@var{times}"@}
17871 @end smallexample
17872
17873 @noindent
17874 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
17875 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
17876 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
17877 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
17878 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
17879 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
17880 which use the same output).
17881
17882 Note: this format is open to change.
17883 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17884
17885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17886
17887 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17888 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17889
17890 @subsubheading Example
17891
17892 @smallexample
17893 (gdb)
17894 -break-insert main
17895 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
17896 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
17897 (gdb)
17898 -break-insert -t foo
17899 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
17900 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
17901 (gdb)
17902 -break-list
17903 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17904 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17905 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17906 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17907 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17908 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17909 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17910 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17911 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
17912 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
17913 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17914 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
17915 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17916 (gdb)
17917 -break-insert -r foo.*
17918 ~int foo(int, int);
17919 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
17920 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
17921 (gdb)
17922 @end smallexample
17923
17924 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17925 @findex -break-list
17926
17927 @subsubheading Synopsis
17928
17929 @smallexample
17930 -break-list
17931 @end smallexample
17932
17933 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17934
17935 @table @samp
17936 @item Number
17937 number of the breakpoint
17938 @item Type
17939 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17940 @item Disposition
17941 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17942 or @samp{nokeep}
17943 @item Enabled
17944 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17945 @item Address
17946 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17947 @item What
17948 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17949 name, line number
17950 @item Times
17951 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17952 @end table
17953
17954 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17955 @code{body} field is an empty list.
17956
17957 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17958
17959 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17960
17961 @subsubheading Example
17962
17963 @smallexample
17964 (gdb)
17965 -break-list
17966 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17967 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17968 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17969 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17970 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17971 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17972 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17973 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17974 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17975 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17976 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17977 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17978 (gdb)
17979 @end smallexample
17980
17981 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17982
17983 @smallexample
17984 (gdb)
17985 -break-list
17986 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17987 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17988 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17989 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17990 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17991 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17992 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17993 body=[]@}
17994 (gdb)
17995 @end smallexample
17996
17997 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17998 @findex -break-watch
17999
18000 @subsubheading Synopsis
18001
18002 @smallexample
18003 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18004 @end smallexample
18005
18006 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18007 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18008 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18009 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18010 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18011 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18012 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18013 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18014
18015 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18016 breakpoints inserted.
18017
18018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18019
18020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18021 @samp{rwatch}.
18022
18023 @subsubheading Example
18024
18025 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18026
18027 @smallexample
18028 (gdb)
18029 -break-watch x
18030 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18031 (gdb)
18032 -exec-continue
18033 ^running
18034 (gdb)
18035 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18036 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18037 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18038 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18039 (gdb)
18040 @end smallexample
18041
18042 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18043 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18044 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18045
18046 @smallexample
18047 (gdb)
18048 -break-watch C
18049 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18050 (gdb)
18051 -exec-continue
18052 ^running
18053 (gdb)
18054 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18055 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18056 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18057 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18058 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18059 (gdb)
18060 -exec-continue
18061 ^running
18062 (gdb)
18063 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18064 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18065 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18066 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18067 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18068 (gdb)
18069 @end smallexample
18070
18071 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18072 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18073 deleted.
18074
18075 @smallexample
18076 (gdb)
18077 -break-watch C
18078 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18079 (gdb)
18080 -break-list
18081 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18082 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18083 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18084 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18085 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18086 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18087 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18088 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18089 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18090 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18091 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18092 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18093 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18094 (gdb)
18095 -exec-continue
18096 ^running
18097 (gdb)
18098 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18099 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18100 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18101 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18102 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18103 (gdb)
18104 -break-list
18105 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18106 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18107 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18108 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18109 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18110 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18111 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18112 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18113 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18114 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18115 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18116 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18117 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18118 (gdb)
18119 -exec-continue
18120 ^running
18121 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18122 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18123 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18124 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18125 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18126 (gdb)
18127 -break-list
18128 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18129 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18130 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18131 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18132 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18133 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18134 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18135 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18136 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18137 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18138 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18139 times="1"@}]@}
18140 (gdb)
18141 @end smallexample
18142
18143 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18144 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18145 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18146
18147 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18148 @findex -exec-arguments
18149
18150
18151 @subsubheading Synopsis
18152
18153 @smallexample
18154 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18155 @end smallexample
18156
18157 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18158 @samp{-exec-run}.
18159
18160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18161
18162 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18163
18164 @subsubheading Example
18165
18166 @c FIXME!
18167 Don't have one around.
18168
18169
18170 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18171 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18172
18173 @subsubheading Synopsis
18174
18175 @smallexample
18176 -exec-show-arguments
18177 @end smallexample
18178
18179 Print the arguments of the program.
18180
18181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18182
18183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18184
18185 @subsubheading Example
18186 N.A.
18187
18188
18189 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18190 @findex -environment-cd
18191
18192 @subsubheading Synopsis
18193
18194 @smallexample
18195 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18196 @end smallexample
18197
18198 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18199
18200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18201
18202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18203
18204 @subsubheading Example
18205
18206 @smallexample
18207 (gdb)
18208 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18209 ^done
18210 (gdb)
18211 @end smallexample
18212
18213
18214 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18215 @findex -environment-directory
18216
18217 @subsubheading Synopsis
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18221 @end smallexample
18222
18223 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18224 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18225 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18226 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18227 occurs as normal.
18228 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18229 multiple directories in a single command
18230 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18231 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18232 If blanks are needed as
18233 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18234 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18235 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18236 character must not be used
18237 in any directory name.
18238 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18239
18240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18241
18242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18243
18244 @subsubheading Example
18245
18246 @smallexample
18247 (gdb)
18248 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18249 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18250 (gdb)
18251 -environment-directory ""
18252 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18253 (gdb)
18254 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18255 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18256 (gdb)
18257 -environment-directory -r
18258 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18259 (gdb)
18260 @end smallexample
18261
18262
18263 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18264 @findex -environment-path
18265
18266 @subsubheading Synopsis
18267
18268 @smallexample
18269 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18270 @end smallexample
18271
18272 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18273 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18274 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18275 supplied in addition to the
18276 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18277 occurs as normal.
18278 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18279 multiple directories in a single command
18280 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18281 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18282 If blanks are needed as
18283 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18284 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18285 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18286 character must not be used
18287 in any directory name.
18288 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18289
18290
18291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18292
18293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18294
18295 @subsubheading Example
18296
18297 @smallexample
18298 (gdb)
18299 -environment-path
18300 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18301 (gdb)
18302 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18303 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18304 (gdb)
18305 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18306 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18307 (gdb)
18308 @end smallexample
18309
18310
18311 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18312 @findex -environment-pwd
18313
18314 @subsubheading Synopsis
18315
18316 @smallexample
18317 -environment-pwd
18318 @end smallexample
18319
18320 Show the current working directory.
18321
18322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18323
18324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18325
18326 @subsubheading Example
18327
18328 @smallexample
18329 (gdb)
18330 -environment-pwd
18331 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18332 (gdb)
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18336 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18337 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18338
18339
18340 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18341 @findex -thread-info
18342
18343 @subsubheading Synopsis
18344
18345 @smallexample
18346 -thread-info
18347 @end smallexample
18348
18349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18350
18351 No equivalent.
18352
18353 @subsubheading Example
18354 N.A.
18355
18356
18357 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18358 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18359
18360 @subsubheading Synopsis
18361
18362 @smallexample
18363 -thread-list-all-threads
18364 @end smallexample
18365
18366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18367
18368 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18369
18370 @subsubheading Example
18371 N.A.
18372
18373
18374 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18375 @findex -thread-list-ids
18376
18377 @subsubheading Synopsis
18378
18379 @smallexample
18380 -thread-list-ids
18381 @end smallexample
18382
18383 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18384 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18385
18386 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18387
18388 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18389
18390 @subsubheading Example
18391
18392 No threads present, besides the main process:
18393
18394 @smallexample
18395 (gdb)
18396 -thread-list-ids
18397 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18398 (gdb)
18399 @end smallexample
18400
18401
18402 Several threads:
18403
18404 @smallexample
18405 (gdb)
18406 -thread-list-ids
18407 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18408 number-of-threads="3"
18409 (gdb)
18410 @end smallexample
18411
18412
18413 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18414 @findex -thread-select
18415
18416 @subsubheading Synopsis
18417
18418 @smallexample
18419 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18420 @end smallexample
18421
18422 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18423 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18424
18425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18426
18427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18428
18429 @subsubheading Example
18430
18431 @smallexample
18432 (gdb)
18433 -exec-next
18434 ^running
18435 (gdb)
18436 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18437 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18438 (gdb)
18439 -thread-list-ids
18440 ^done,
18441 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18442 number-of-threads="3"
18443 (gdb)
18444 -thread-select 3
18445 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18446 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18447 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18448 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18449 (gdb)
18450 @end smallexample
18451
18452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18453 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18454 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18455
18456 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18457 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18458 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18459 other cases.
18460
18461 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18462 @findex -exec-continue
18463
18464 @subsubheading Synopsis
18465
18466 @smallexample
18467 -exec-continue
18468 @end smallexample
18469
18470 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18471 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18472
18473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18474
18475 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18476
18477 @subsubheading Example
18478
18479 @smallexample
18480 -exec-continue
18481 ^running
18482 (gdb)
18483 @@Hello world
18484 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18485 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18486 (gdb)
18487 @end smallexample
18488
18489
18490 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18491 @findex -exec-finish
18492
18493 @subsubheading Synopsis
18494
18495 @smallexample
18496 -exec-finish
18497 @end smallexample
18498
18499 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18500 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18501
18502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18503
18504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18505
18506 @subsubheading Example
18507
18508 Function returning @code{void}.
18509
18510 @smallexample
18511 -exec-finish
18512 ^running
18513 (gdb)
18514 @@hello from foo
18515 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18516 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18517 (gdb)
18518 @end smallexample
18519
18520 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18521 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18522 value itself.
18523
18524 @smallexample
18525 -exec-finish
18526 ^running
18527 (gdb)
18528 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18529 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18530 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18531 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18532 (gdb)
18533 @end smallexample
18534
18535
18536 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18537 @findex -exec-interrupt
18538
18539 @subsubheading Synopsis
18540
18541 @smallexample
18542 -exec-interrupt
18543 @end smallexample
18544
18545 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18546 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18547 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18548 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18549 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18550
18551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18552
18553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18554
18555 @subsubheading Example
18556
18557 @smallexample
18558 (gdb)
18559 111-exec-continue
18560 111^running
18561
18562 (gdb)
18563 222-exec-interrupt
18564 222^done
18565 (gdb)
18566 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18567 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18568 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18569 (gdb)
18570
18571 (gdb)
18572 -exec-interrupt
18573 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18574 (gdb)
18575 @end smallexample
18576
18577
18578 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18579 @findex -exec-next
18580
18581 @subsubheading Synopsis
18582
18583 @smallexample
18584 -exec-next
18585 @end smallexample
18586
18587 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18588 of the next source line is reached.
18589
18590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18591
18592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18593
18594 @subsubheading Example
18595
18596 @smallexample
18597 -exec-next
18598 ^running
18599 (gdb)
18600 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18601 (gdb)
18602 @end smallexample
18603
18604
18605 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18606 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18607
18608 @subsubheading Synopsis
18609
18610 @smallexample
18611 -exec-next-instruction
18612 @end smallexample
18613
18614 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18615 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18616 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18617 printed as well.
18618
18619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18620
18621 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18622
18623 @subsubheading Example
18624
18625 @smallexample
18626 (gdb)
18627 -exec-next-instruction
18628 ^running
18629
18630 (gdb)
18631 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18632 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18633 (gdb)
18634 @end smallexample
18635
18636
18637 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18638 @findex -exec-return
18639
18640 @subsubheading Synopsis
18641
18642 @smallexample
18643 -exec-return
18644 @end smallexample
18645
18646 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18647 Displays the new current frame.
18648
18649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18650
18651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18652
18653 @subsubheading Example
18654
18655 @smallexample
18656 (gdb)
18657 200-break-insert callee4
18658 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18659 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18660 (gdb)
18661 000-exec-run
18662 000^running
18663 (gdb)
18664 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18665 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18666 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18667 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18668 (gdb)
18669 205-break-delete
18670 205^done
18671 (gdb)
18672 111-exec-return
18673 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18674 args=[@{name="strarg",
18675 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18676 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18677 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18678 (gdb)
18679 @end smallexample
18680
18681
18682 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18683 @findex -exec-run
18684
18685 @subsubheading Synopsis
18686
18687 @smallexample
18688 -exec-run
18689 @end smallexample
18690
18691 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18692 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18693 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18694 the program has exited exceptionally.
18695
18696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18697
18698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18699
18700 @subsubheading Examples
18701
18702 @smallexample
18703 (gdb)
18704 -break-insert main
18705 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18706 (gdb)
18707 -exec-run
18708 ^running
18709 (gdb)
18710 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18711 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18712 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18713 (gdb)
18714 @end smallexample
18715
18716 @noindent
18717 Program exited normally:
18718
18719 @smallexample
18720 (gdb)
18721 -exec-run
18722 ^running
18723 (gdb)
18724 x = 55
18725 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18726 (gdb)
18727 @end smallexample
18728
18729 @noindent
18730 Program exited exceptionally:
18731
18732 @smallexample
18733 (gdb)
18734 -exec-run
18735 ^running
18736 (gdb)
18737 x = 55
18738 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18739 (gdb)
18740 @end smallexample
18741
18742 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18743 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18744
18745 @smallexample
18746 (gdb)
18747 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18748 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18749 @end smallexample
18750
18751
18752 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18753
18754
18755 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18756 @findex -exec-step
18757
18758 @subsubheading Synopsis
18759
18760 @smallexample
18761 -exec-step
18762 @end smallexample
18763
18764 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18765 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
18766 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
18767 function.
18768
18769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18770
18771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18772
18773 @subsubheading Example
18774
18775 Stepping into a function:
18776
18777 @smallexample
18778 -exec-step
18779 ^running
18780 (gdb)
18781 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18782 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18783 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18784 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18785 (gdb)
18786 @end smallexample
18787
18788 Regular stepping:
18789
18790 @smallexample
18791 -exec-step
18792 ^running
18793 (gdb)
18794 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18795 (gdb)
18796 @end smallexample
18797
18798
18799 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18800 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18801
18802 @subsubheading Synopsis
18803
18804 @smallexample
18805 -exec-step-instruction
18806 @end smallexample
18807
18808 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
18809 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
18810 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
18811 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18812 well.
18813
18814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18815
18816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18817
18818 @subsubheading Example
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 (gdb)
18822 -exec-step-instruction
18823 ^running
18824
18825 (gdb)
18826 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18827 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18828 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18829 (gdb)
18830 -exec-step-instruction
18831 ^running
18832
18833 (gdb)
18834 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18835 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18836 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18837 (gdb)
18838 @end smallexample
18839
18840
18841 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
18842 @findex -exec-until
18843
18844 @subsubheading Synopsis
18845
18846 @smallexample
18847 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
18848 @end smallexample
18849
18850 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
18851 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
18852 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
18853 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
18854
18855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18856
18857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
18858
18859 @subsubheading Example
18860
18861 @smallexample
18862 (gdb)
18863 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
18864 ^running
18865 (gdb)
18866 x = 55
18867 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18868 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
18869 (gdb)
18870 @end smallexample
18871
18872 @ignore
18873 @subheading -file-clear
18874 Is this going away????
18875 @end ignore
18876
18877 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18878 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
18879 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
18880
18881
18882 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
18883 @findex -stack-info-frame
18884
18885 @subsubheading Synopsis
18886
18887 @smallexample
18888 -stack-info-frame
18889 @end smallexample
18890
18891 Get info on the selected frame.
18892
18893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18894
18895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
18896 (without arguments).
18897
18898 @subsubheading Example
18899
18900 @smallexample
18901 (gdb)
18902 -stack-info-frame
18903 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18904 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18905 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
18906 (gdb)
18907 @end smallexample
18908
18909 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
18910 @findex -stack-info-depth
18911
18912 @subsubheading Synopsis
18913
18914 @smallexample
18915 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
18916 @end smallexample
18917
18918 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
18919 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
18920
18921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18922
18923 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
18924
18925 @subsubheading Example
18926
18927 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
18928
18929 @smallexample
18930 (gdb)
18931 -stack-info-depth
18932 ^done,depth="12"
18933 (gdb)
18934 -stack-info-depth 4
18935 ^done,depth="4"
18936 (gdb)
18937 -stack-info-depth 12
18938 ^done,depth="12"
18939 (gdb)
18940 -stack-info-depth 11
18941 ^done,depth="11"
18942 (gdb)
18943 -stack-info-depth 13
18944 ^done,depth="12"
18945 (gdb)
18946 @end smallexample
18947
18948 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
18949 @findex -stack-list-arguments
18950
18951 @subsubheading Synopsis
18952
18953 @smallexample
18954 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
18955 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
18956 @end smallexample
18957
18958 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
18959 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
18960 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
18961 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
18962 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
18963 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
18964 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
18965 which case only existing frames will be returned.
18966
18967 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
18968 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
18969 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
18970
18971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18972
18973 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
18974 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
18975 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
18976
18977 @subsubheading Example
18978
18979 @smallexample
18980 (gdb)
18981 -stack-list-frames
18982 ^done,
18983 stack=[
18984 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18985 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18986 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
18987 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18988 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18989 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
18990 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
18991 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18992 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
18993 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
18994 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
18996 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
18997 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18998 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
18999 (gdb)
19000 -stack-list-arguments 0
19001 ^done,
19002 stack-args=[
19003 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19004 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19005 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19006 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19007 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19008 (gdb)
19009 -stack-list-arguments 1
19010 ^done,
19011 stack-args=[
19012 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19013 frame=@{level="1",
19014 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19015 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19016 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19017 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19018 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19019 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19020 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19021 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19022 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19023 (gdb)
19024 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19025 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19026 (gdb)
19027 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19028 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19029 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19030 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19031 (gdb)
19032 @end smallexample
19033
19034 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19035
19036
19037 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19038 @findex -stack-list-frames
19039
19040 @subsubheading Synopsis
19041
19042 @smallexample
19043 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19044 @end smallexample
19045
19046 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19047 following info:
19048
19049 @table @samp
19050 @item @var{level}
19051 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19052 @item @var{addr}
19053 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19054 @item @var{func}
19055 Function name.
19056 @item @var{file}
19057 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19058 @item @var{line}
19059 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19060 @end table
19061
19062 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19063 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19064 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19065 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19066 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19067 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19068 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19069
19070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19071
19072 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19073
19074 @subsubheading Example
19075
19076 Full stack backtrace:
19077
19078 @smallexample
19079 (gdb)
19080 -stack-list-frames
19081 ^done,stack=
19082 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19083 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19084 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19085 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19086 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19087 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19088 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19089 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19090 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19091 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19092 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19093 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19094 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19095 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19096 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19097 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19098 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19099 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19100 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19101 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19102 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19103 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19104 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19105 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19106 (gdb)
19107 @end smallexample
19108
19109 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19110
19111 @smallexample
19112 (gdb)
19113 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19114 ^done,stack=
19115 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19116 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19117 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19118 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19119 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19120 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19121 (gdb)
19122 @end smallexample
19123
19124 Show a single frame:
19125
19126 @smallexample
19127 (gdb)
19128 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19129 ^done,stack=
19130 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19131 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19132 (gdb)
19133 @end smallexample
19134
19135
19136 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19137 @findex -stack-list-locals
19138
19139 @subsubheading Synopsis
19140
19141 @smallexample
19142 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19143 @end smallexample
19144
19145 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19146 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19147 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19148 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19149 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19150 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19151 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19152 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19153 more detail.
19154
19155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19156
19157 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19158
19159 @subsubheading Example
19160
19161 @smallexample
19162 (gdb)
19163 -stack-list-locals 0
19164 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19165 (gdb)
19166 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19167 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19168 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19169 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19170 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19171 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19172 (gdb)
19173 @end smallexample
19174
19175
19176 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19177 @findex -stack-select-frame
19178
19179 @subsubheading Synopsis
19180
19181 @smallexample
19182 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19183 @end smallexample
19184
19185 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19186 the stack.
19187
19188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19189
19190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19191 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19192
19193 @subsubheading Example
19194
19195 @smallexample
19196 (gdb)
19197 -stack-select-frame 2
19198 ^done
19199 (gdb)
19200 @end smallexample
19201
19202 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19203 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19204 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19205
19206 @ignore
19207
19208 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19209
19210 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19211 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19212 used by @code{Insight}.
19213
19214 The two main reasons for that are:
19215
19216 @enumerate 1
19217 @item
19218 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19219
19220 @item
19221 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19222 now).
19223 @end enumerate
19224
19225 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19226 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19227 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19228 hints about their use.
19229
19230 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19231 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19232 least, the following operations:
19233
19234 @itemize @bullet
19235 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19236 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19237 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19238 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19239 @end itemize
19240
19241 @end ignore
19242
19243 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19244
19245 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19246
19247 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19248 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19249 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19250 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19251 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19252 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19253 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19254 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19255 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19256 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19257 object, or to change display format.
19258
19259 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19260 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19261 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19262 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19263 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19264 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19265 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19266 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19267 child will be created.
19268
19269 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19270 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19271 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19272 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19273 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19274
19275 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19276 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19277 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19278 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19279 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19280 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19281 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19282 variables that frontend has created.
19283
19284 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19285 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19286 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19287 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19288 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19289 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19290 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19291 implicitly updated.
19292
19293 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19294 access this functionality:
19295
19296 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19297 @item @strong{Operation}
19298 @tab @strong{Description}
19299
19300 @item @code{-var-create}
19301 @tab create a variable object
19302 @item @code{-var-delete}
19303 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19304 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19305 @tab set the display format of this variable
19306 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19307 @tab show the display format of this variable
19308 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19309 @tab tells how many children this object has
19310 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19311 @tab return a list of the object's children
19312 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19313 @tab show the type of this variable object
19314 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19315 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19316 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19317 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19318 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19319 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19320 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19321 @tab get the value of this variable
19322 @item @code{-var-assign}
19323 @tab set the value of this variable
19324 @item @code{-var-update}
19325 @tab update the variable and its children
19326 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19327 @tab set frozeness attribute
19328 @end multitable
19329
19330 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19331 how it can be used.
19332
19333 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19334
19335 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19336 @findex -var-create
19337
19338 @subsubheading Synopsis
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19342 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19343 @end smallexample
19344
19345 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19346 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19347 register.
19348
19349 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19350 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19351 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19352 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19353 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19354
19355 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19356 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19357 frame should be used.
19358
19359 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19360 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19361
19362 @itemize @bullet
19363 @item
19364 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19365
19366 @item
19367 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19368
19369 @item
19370 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19371 @end itemize
19372
19373 @subsubheading Result
19374
19375 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19376 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19377 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19378
19379 @smallexample
19380 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19381 @end smallexample
19382
19383
19384 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19385 @findex -var-delete
19386
19387 @subsubheading Synopsis
19388
19389 @smallexample
19390 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19391 @end smallexample
19392
19393 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19394 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19395
19396 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19397
19398
19399 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19400 @findex -var-set-format
19401
19402 @subsubheading Synopsis
19403
19404 @smallexample
19405 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19406 @end smallexample
19407
19408 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19409 @var{format-spec}.
19410
19411 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19412
19413 @smallexample
19414 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19415 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19416 @end smallexample
19417
19418 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19419 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19420 for pointers, etc.).
19421
19422 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19423 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19424
19425 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19426 @findex -var-show-format
19427
19428 @subsubheading Synopsis
19429
19430 @smallexample
19431 -var-show-format @var{name}
19432 @end smallexample
19433
19434 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19435
19436 @smallexample
19437 @var{format} @expansion{}
19438 @var{format-spec}
19439 @end smallexample
19440
19441
19442 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19443 @findex -var-info-num-children
19444
19445 @subsubheading Synopsis
19446
19447 @smallexample
19448 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19449 @end smallexample
19450
19451 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 numchild=@var{n}
19455 @end smallexample
19456
19457
19458 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19459 @findex -var-list-children
19460
19461 @subsubheading Synopsis
19462
19463 @smallexample
19464 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19465 @end smallexample
19466 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19467
19468 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19469 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19470 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19471 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19472 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19473 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19474 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19475 and unions.
19476
19477 @subsubheading Example
19478
19479 @smallexample
19480 (gdb)
19481 -var-list-children n
19482 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19483 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19484 (gdb)
19485 -var-list-children --all-values n
19486 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19487 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19488 @end smallexample
19489
19490
19491 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19492 @findex -var-info-type
19493
19494 @subsubheading Synopsis
19495
19496 @smallexample
19497 -var-info-type @var{name}
19498 @end smallexample
19499
19500 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19501 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19502 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19503
19504 @smallexample
19505 type=@var{typename}
19506 @end smallexample
19507
19508
19509 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19510 @findex -var-info-expression
19511
19512 @subsubheading Synopsis
19513
19514 @smallexample
19515 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19516 @end smallexample
19517
19518 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
19519 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
19520 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
19521
19522 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
19523 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
19524
19525 @smallexample
19526 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
19527 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
19528 @end smallexample
19529
19530 @noindent
19531 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19532
19533 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
19534 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
19535 is of limited use.
19536
19537 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
19538 @findex -var-info-path-expression
19539
19540 @subsubheading Synopsis
19541
19542 @smallexample
19543 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
19544 @end smallexample
19545
19546 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
19547 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
19548 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
19549 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
19550 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
19551 watchpoint from a variable object.
19552
19553 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
19554 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
19555 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
19556 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
19557 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
19558 @smallexample
19559 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
19560 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
19561 @end smallexample
19562
19563 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19564 @findex -var-show-attributes
19565
19566 @subsubheading Synopsis
19567
19568 @smallexample
19569 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19570 @end smallexample
19571
19572 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19573
19574 @smallexample
19575 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19576 @end smallexample
19577
19578 @noindent
19579 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19580
19581 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19582 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19583
19584 @subsubheading Synopsis
19585
19586 @smallexample
19587 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19588 @end smallexample
19589
19590 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19591 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19592 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19593
19594 @smallexample
19595 value=@var{value}
19596 @end smallexample
19597
19598 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19599 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19600
19601 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19602 @findex -var-assign
19603
19604 @subsubheading Synopsis
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19608 @end smallexample
19609
19610 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19611 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19612 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19613 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19614
19615 @subsubheading Example
19616
19617 @smallexample
19618 (gdb)
19619 -var-assign var1 3
19620 ^done,value="3"
19621 (gdb)
19622 -var-update *
19623 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19624 (gdb)
19625 @end smallexample
19626
19627 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19628 @findex -var-update
19629
19630 @subsubheading Synopsis
19631
19632 @smallexample
19633 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19634 @end smallexample
19635
19636 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19637 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19638 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19639 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19640 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19641 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19642 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
19643 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
19644 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19645 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19646 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
19647 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
19648 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
19649
19650
19651 @subsubheading Example
19652
19653 @smallexample
19654 (gdb)
19655 -var-assign var1 3
19656 ^done,value="3"
19657 (gdb)
19658 -var-update --all-values var1
19659 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19660 type_changed="false"@}]
19661 (gdb)
19662 @end smallexample
19663
19664 @anchor{-var-update}
19665 The field in_scope may take three values:
19666
19667 @table @code
19668 @item "true"
19669 The variable object's current value is valid.
19670
19671 @item "false"
19672 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
19673 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
19674 scope.
19675
19676 @item "invalid"
19677 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
19678 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
19679 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
19680 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
19681 objects.
19682 @end table
19683
19684 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
19685 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
19686
19687 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
19688 @findex -var-set-frozen
19689 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
19690
19691 @subsubheading Synopsis
19692
19693 @smallexample
19694 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
19695 @end smallexample
19696
19697 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
19698 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
19699 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
19700 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
19701 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
19702 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
19703 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
19704 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
19705 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
19706 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
19707 @code{-var-update} does.
19708
19709 @subsubheading Example
19710
19711 @smallexample
19712 (gdb)
19713 -var-set-frozen V 1
19714 ^done
19715 (gdb)
19716 @end smallexample
19717
19718
19719 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19720 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19721 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19722
19723 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19724 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19725 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19726 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19727
19728 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19729 @c @subheading -data-assign
19730 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19731 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
19732 @c set variable
19733 @c @subsubheading Example
19734 @c N.A.
19735
19736 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19737 @findex -data-disassemble
19738
19739 @subsubheading Synopsis
19740
19741 @smallexample
19742 -data-disassemble
19743 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19744 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19745 -- @var{mode}
19746 @end smallexample
19747
19748 @noindent
19749 Where:
19750
19751 @table @samp
19752 @item @var{start-addr}
19753 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19754 @item @var{end-addr}
19755 is the end address
19756 @item @var{filename}
19757 is the name of the file to disassemble
19758 @item @var{linenum}
19759 is the line number to disassemble around
19760 @item @var{lines}
19761 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19762 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19763 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19764 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19765 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19766 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19767 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19768 are displayed.
19769 @item @var{mode}
19770 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19771 disassembly).
19772 @end table
19773
19774 @subsubheading Result
19775
19776 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19777
19778 @itemize @bullet
19779 @item Address
19780 @item Func-name
19781 @item Offset
19782 @item Instruction
19783 @end itemize
19784
19785 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19786 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
19787
19788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19789
19790 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19791
19792 @subsubheading Example
19793
19794 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19795
19796 @smallexample
19797 (gdb)
19798 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19799 ^done,
19800 asm_insns=[
19801 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19802 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19803 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19804 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19805 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19806 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19807 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19808 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19809 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19810 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19811 (gdb)
19812 @end smallexample
19813
19814 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19815 @code{main}.
19816
19817 @smallexample
19818 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19819 ^done,asm_insns=[
19820 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19821 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19822 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19823 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19824 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19825 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19826 [@dots{}]
19827 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19828 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19829 (gdb)
19830 @end smallexample
19831
19832 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19833
19834 @smallexample
19835 (gdb)
19836 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19837 ^done,asm_insns=[
19838 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19839 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19840 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19841 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19842 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19843 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19844 (gdb)
19845 @end smallexample
19846
19847 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19848
19849 @smallexample
19850 (gdb)
19851 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19852 ^done,asm_insns=[
19853 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19854 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19855 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19856 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19857 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19858 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
19859 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19860 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19861 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19862 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19863 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19864 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
19865 (gdb)
19866 @end smallexample
19867
19868
19869 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
19870 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
19871
19872 @subsubheading Synopsis
19873
19874 @smallexample
19875 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
19876 @end smallexample
19877
19878 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
19879 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
19880 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
19881
19882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19883
19884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
19885 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
19886 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
19887
19888 @subsubheading Example
19889
19890 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
19891 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
19892 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
19893 output.
19894
19895 @smallexample
19896 211-data-evaluate-expression A
19897 211^done,value="1"
19898 (gdb)
19899 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
19900 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
19901 (gdb)
19902 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
19903 411^done,value="4"
19904 (gdb)
19905 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
19906 511^done,value="4"
19907 (gdb)
19908 @end smallexample
19909
19910
19911 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
19912 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
19913
19914 @subsubheading Synopsis
19915
19916 @smallexample
19917 -data-list-changed-registers
19918 @end smallexample
19919
19920 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
19921
19922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19923
19924 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
19925 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
19926
19927 @subsubheading Example
19928
19929 On a PPC MBX board:
19930
19931 @smallexample
19932 (gdb)
19933 -exec-continue
19934 ^running
19935
19936 (gdb)
19937 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
19938 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
19939 (gdb)
19940 -data-list-changed-registers
19941 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
19942 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
19943 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
19944 (gdb)
19945 @end smallexample
19946
19947
19948 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
19949 @findex -data-list-register-names
19950
19951 @subsubheading Synopsis
19952
19953 @smallexample
19954 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
19955 @end smallexample
19956
19957 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
19958 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
19959 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
19960 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
19961 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
19962 include empty register names.
19963
19964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19965
19966 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
19967 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
19968 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
19969
19970 @subsubheading Example
19971
19972 For the PPC MBX board:
19973 @smallexample
19974 (gdb)
19975 -data-list-register-names
19976 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
19977 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
19978 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
19979 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
19980 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
19981 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
19982 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
19983 (gdb)
19984 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
19985 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
19986 (gdb)
19987 @end smallexample
19988
19989 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
19990 @findex -data-list-register-values
19991
19992 @subsubheading Synopsis
19993
19994 @smallexample
19995 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
19996 @end smallexample
19997
19998 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
19999 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20000 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20001 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20002
20003 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20004
20005 @table @code
20006 @item x
20007 Hexadecimal
20008 @item o
20009 Octal
20010 @item t
20011 Binary
20012 @item d
20013 Decimal
20014 @item r
20015 Raw
20016 @item N
20017 Natural
20018 @end table
20019
20020 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20021
20022 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20023 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20024
20025 @subsubheading Example
20026
20027 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20028 don't appear in the actual output):
20029
20030 @smallexample
20031 (gdb)
20032 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20033 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20034 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20035 (gdb)
20036 -data-list-register-values x
20037 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20038 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20039 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20040 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20041 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20042 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20043 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20044 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20045 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20046 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20047 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20048 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20049 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20050 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20051 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20052 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20053 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20054 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20055 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20056 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20057 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20058 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20059 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20060 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20061 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20062 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20063 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20064 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20065 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20066 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20067 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20068 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20069 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20070 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20071 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20072 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20073 (gdb)
20074 @end smallexample
20075
20076
20077 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20078 @findex -data-read-memory
20079
20080 @subsubheading Synopsis
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20084 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20085 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20086 @end smallexample
20087
20088 @noindent
20089 where:
20090
20091 @table @samp
20092 @item @var{address}
20093 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20094 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20095 quoted using the C convention.
20096
20097 @item @var{word-format}
20098 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20099 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20100 ,Output Formats}).
20101
20102 @item @var{word-size}
20103 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20104
20105 @item @var{nr-rows}
20106 The number of rows in the output table.
20107
20108 @item @var{nr-cols}
20109 The number of columns in the output table.
20110
20111 @item @var{aschar}
20112 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20113 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20114 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20115 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20116
20117 @item @var{byte-offset}
20118 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20119 @end table
20120
20121 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20122 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20123 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20124 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20125 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20126 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20127 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20128 @samp{addr}.
20129
20130 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20131 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20132 @samp{prev-page}.
20133
20134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20135
20136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20137 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20138
20139 @subsubheading Example
20140
20141 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20142 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20143 word. Display each word in hex.
20144
20145 @smallexample
20146 (gdb)
20147 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20148 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20149 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20150 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20151 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20152 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20153 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20154 (gdb)
20155 @end smallexample
20156
20157 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20158 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20159
20160 @smallexample
20161 (gdb)
20162 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20163 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20164 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20165 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20166 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20167 (gdb)
20168 @end smallexample
20169
20170 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20171 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20172 used as the non-printable character.
20173
20174 @smallexample
20175 (gdb)
20176 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20177 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20178 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20179 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20180 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20181 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20182 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20183 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20184 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20185 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20186 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20187 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20188 (gdb)
20189 @end smallexample
20190
20191 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20192 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20193 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20194
20195 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20196
20197 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20198
20199 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20200
20201 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20202
20203 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20204
20205 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20206
20207 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20208
20209 @c @subheading -trace-find
20210
20211 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20212
20213 @c @subheading -trace-info
20214
20215 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20216
20217 @c @subheading -trace-list
20218
20219 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20220
20221 @c @subheading -trace-save
20222
20223 @c @subheading -trace-start
20224
20225 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20226
20227
20228 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20229 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20230 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20231
20232
20233 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20234 @findex -symbol-info-address
20235
20236 @subsubheading Synopsis
20237
20238 @smallexample
20239 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20240 @end smallexample
20241
20242 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20243
20244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20245
20246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20247
20248 @subsubheading Example
20249 N.A.
20250
20251
20252 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20253 @findex -symbol-info-file
20254
20255 @subsubheading Synopsis
20256
20257 @smallexample
20258 -symbol-info-file
20259 @end smallexample
20260
20261 Show the file for the symbol.
20262
20263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20264
20265 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20266 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20267
20268 @subsubheading Example
20269 N.A.
20270
20271
20272 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20273 @findex -symbol-info-function
20274
20275 @subsubheading Synopsis
20276
20277 @smallexample
20278 -symbol-info-function
20279 @end smallexample
20280
20281 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20282
20283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20284
20285 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20286
20287 @subsubheading Example
20288 N.A.
20289
20290
20291 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20292 @findex -symbol-info-line
20293
20294 @subsubheading Synopsis
20295
20296 @smallexample
20297 -symbol-info-line
20298 @end smallexample
20299
20300 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20301
20302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20303
20304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20305 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20306
20307 @subsubheading Example
20308 N.A.
20309
20310
20311 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20312 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20313
20314 @subsubheading Synopsis
20315
20316 @smallexample
20317 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20318 @end smallexample
20319
20320 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20321
20322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20323
20324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20325
20326 @subsubheading Example
20327 N.A.
20328
20329
20330 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20331 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20332
20333 @subsubheading Synopsis
20334
20335 @smallexample
20336 -symbol-list-functions
20337 @end smallexample
20338
20339 List the functions in the executable.
20340
20341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20342
20343 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20344 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20345
20346 @subsubheading Example
20347 N.A.
20348
20349
20350 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20351 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20352
20353 @subsubheading Synopsis
20354
20355 @smallexample
20356 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20357 @end smallexample
20358
20359 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20360 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20361 ascending PC order.
20362
20363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20364
20365 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20366
20367 @subsubheading Example
20368 @smallexample
20369 (gdb)
20370 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20371 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20372 (gdb)
20373 @end smallexample
20374
20375
20376 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20377 @findex -symbol-list-types
20378
20379 @subsubheading Synopsis
20380
20381 @smallexample
20382 -symbol-list-types
20383 @end smallexample
20384
20385 List all the type names.
20386
20387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20388
20389 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20390 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20391
20392 @subsubheading Example
20393 N.A.
20394
20395
20396 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20397 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20398
20399 @subsubheading Synopsis
20400
20401 @smallexample
20402 -symbol-list-variables
20403 @end smallexample
20404
20405 List all the global and static variable names.
20406
20407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20408
20409 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20410
20411 @subsubheading Example
20412 N.A.
20413
20414
20415 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20416 @findex -symbol-locate
20417
20418 @subsubheading Synopsis
20419
20420 @smallexample
20421 -symbol-locate
20422 @end smallexample
20423
20424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20425
20426 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20427
20428 @subsubheading Example
20429 N.A.
20430
20431
20432 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20433 @findex -symbol-type
20434
20435 @subsubheading Synopsis
20436
20437 @smallexample
20438 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20439 @end smallexample
20440
20441 Show type of @var{variable}.
20442
20443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20444
20445 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20446 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20447
20448 @subsubheading Example
20449 N.A.
20450
20451
20452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20453 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20454 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20455
20456 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20457 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20458
20459 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20460 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20461
20462 @subsubheading Synopsis
20463
20464 @smallexample
20465 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20466 @end smallexample
20467
20468 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20469 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20470 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20471 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20472 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20473 notification.
20474
20475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20476
20477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20478
20479 @subsubheading Example
20480
20481 @smallexample
20482 (gdb)
20483 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20484 ^done
20485 (gdb)
20486 @end smallexample
20487
20488
20489 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20490 @findex -file-exec-file
20491
20492 @subsubheading Synopsis
20493
20494 @smallexample
20495 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20496 @end smallexample
20497
20498 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20499 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20500 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20501 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20502 notification.
20503
20504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20505
20506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20507
20508 @subsubheading Example
20509
20510 @smallexample
20511 (gdb)
20512 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20513 ^done
20514 (gdb)
20515 @end smallexample
20516
20517
20518 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20519 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20520
20521 @subsubheading Synopsis
20522
20523 @smallexample
20524 -file-list-exec-sections
20525 @end smallexample
20526
20527 List the sections of the current executable file.
20528
20529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20530
20531 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20532 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20533 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20534
20535 @subsubheading Example
20536 N.A.
20537
20538
20539 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20540 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20541
20542 @subsubheading Synopsis
20543
20544 @smallexample
20545 -file-list-exec-source-file
20546 @end smallexample
20547
20548 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20549 to the current source file for the current executable.
20550
20551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20552
20553 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20554
20555 @subsubheading Example
20556
20557 @smallexample
20558 (gdb)
20559 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20560 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20561 (gdb)
20562 @end smallexample
20563
20564
20565 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20566 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20567
20568 @subsubheading Synopsis
20569
20570 @smallexample
20571 -file-list-exec-source-files
20572 @end smallexample
20573
20574 List the source files for the current executable.
20575
20576 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20577 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20578
20579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20580
20581 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20582 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20583
20584 @subsubheading Example
20585 @smallexample
20586 (gdb)
20587 -file-list-exec-source-files
20588 ^done,files=[
20589 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20590 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20591 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20592 (gdb)
20593 @end smallexample
20594
20595 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20596 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20597
20598 @subsubheading Synopsis
20599
20600 @smallexample
20601 -file-list-shared-libraries
20602 @end smallexample
20603
20604 List the shared libraries in the program.
20605
20606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20607
20608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20609
20610 @subsubheading Example
20611 N.A.
20612
20613
20614 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20615 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20616
20617 @subsubheading Synopsis
20618
20619 @smallexample
20620 -file-list-symbol-files
20621 @end smallexample
20622
20623 List symbol files.
20624
20625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20626
20627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20628
20629 @subsubheading Example
20630 N.A.
20631
20632
20633 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20634 @findex -file-symbol-file
20635
20636 @subsubheading Synopsis
20637
20638 @smallexample
20639 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20640 @end smallexample
20641
20642 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20643 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20644 produced, except for a completion notification.
20645
20646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20647
20648 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20649
20650 @subsubheading Example
20651
20652 @smallexample
20653 (gdb)
20654 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20655 ^done
20656 (gdb)
20657 @end smallexample
20658
20659 @ignore
20660 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20661 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20662 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20663
20664 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20665
20666 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20667
20668 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20669
20670 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20671
20672 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20673
20674 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20675
20676 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20677
20678 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20679
20680 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20681 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20682 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20683
20684 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20685
20686 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20687
20688 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20689
20690 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20691 @end ignore
20692
20693
20694 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20695 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20696 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20697
20698
20699 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20700 @findex -target-attach
20701
20702 @subsubheading Synopsis
20703
20704 @smallexample
20705 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20706 @end smallexample
20707
20708 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20709
20710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20711
20712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20713
20714 @subsubheading Example
20715 N.A.
20716
20717
20718 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20719 @findex -target-compare-sections
20720
20721 @subsubheading Synopsis
20722
20723 @smallexample
20724 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20725 @end smallexample
20726
20727 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20728 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20729
20730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20731
20732 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20733
20734 @subsubheading Example
20735 N.A.
20736
20737
20738 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20739 @findex -target-detach
20740
20741 @subsubheading Synopsis
20742
20743 @smallexample
20744 -target-detach
20745 @end smallexample
20746
20747 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20748 There's no output.
20749
20750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20751
20752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20753
20754 @subsubheading Example
20755
20756 @smallexample
20757 (gdb)
20758 -target-detach
20759 ^done
20760 (gdb)
20761 @end smallexample
20762
20763
20764 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20765 @findex -target-disconnect
20766
20767 @subsubheading Synopsis
20768
20769 @smallexample
20770 -target-disconnect
20771 @end smallexample
20772
20773 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20774 generally not resumed.
20775
20776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20777
20778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20779
20780 @subsubheading Example
20781
20782 @smallexample
20783 (gdb)
20784 -target-disconnect
20785 ^done
20786 (gdb)
20787 @end smallexample
20788
20789
20790 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20791 @findex -target-download
20792
20793 @subsubheading Synopsis
20794
20795 @smallexample
20796 -target-download
20797 @end smallexample
20798
20799 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20800 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20801
20802 @table @samp
20803 @item section
20804 The name of the section.
20805 @item section-sent
20806 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20807 @item section-size
20808 The size of the section.
20809 @item total-sent
20810 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20811 @item total-size
20812 The size of the overall executable to download.
20813 @end table
20814
20815 @noindent
20816 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20817 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20818
20819 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20820 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20821
20822 @table @samp
20823 @item section
20824 The name of the section.
20825 @item section-size
20826 The size of the section.
20827 @item total-size
20828 The size of the overall executable to download.
20829 @end table
20830
20831 @noindent
20832 At the end, a summary is printed.
20833
20834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20835
20836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20837
20838 @subsubheading Example
20839
20840 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20841 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20842
20843 @smallexample
20844 (gdb)
20845 -target-download
20846 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20847 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20848 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20849 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20850 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20851 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20852 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20853 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20854 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20855 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20856 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20857 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20858 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20859 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20860 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20861 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20862 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20863 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20864 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20865 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20866 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20867 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20868 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20869 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20870 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20871 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20872 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20873 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20874 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20875 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20876 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20877 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20878 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20879 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20880 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20881 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20882 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20883 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20884 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20885 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20886 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20887 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20888 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20889 write-rate="429"
20890 (gdb)
20891 @end smallexample
20892
20893
20894 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20895 @findex -target-exec-status
20896
20897 @subsubheading Synopsis
20898
20899 @smallexample
20900 -target-exec-status
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20904 not, for instance).
20905
20906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20907
20908 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20909
20910 @subsubheading Example
20911 N.A.
20912
20913
20914 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20915 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20916
20917 @subsubheading Synopsis
20918
20919 @smallexample
20920 -target-list-available-targets
20921 @end smallexample
20922
20923 List the possible targets to connect to.
20924
20925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20926
20927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20928
20929 @subsubheading Example
20930 N.A.
20931
20932
20933 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20934 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20935
20936 @subsubheading Synopsis
20937
20938 @smallexample
20939 -target-list-current-targets
20940 @end smallexample
20941
20942 Describe the current target.
20943
20944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20945
20946 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20947 other things).
20948
20949 @subsubheading Example
20950 N.A.
20951
20952
20953 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20954 @findex -target-list-parameters
20955
20956 @subsubheading Synopsis
20957
20958 @smallexample
20959 -target-list-parameters
20960 @end smallexample
20961
20962 @c ????
20963
20964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20965
20966 No equivalent.
20967
20968 @subsubheading Example
20969 N.A.
20970
20971
20972 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20973 @findex -target-select
20974
20975 @subsubheading Synopsis
20976
20977 @smallexample
20978 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20979 @end smallexample
20980
20981 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20982
20983 @table @samp
20984 @item @var{type}
20985 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20986 @item @var{parameters}
20987 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20988 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
20989 @end table
20990
20991 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20992 which the target program is, in the following form:
20993
20994 @smallexample
20995 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20996 args=[@var{arg list}]
20997 @end smallexample
20998
20999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21000
21001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21002
21003 @subsubheading Example
21004
21005 @smallexample
21006 (gdb)
21007 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21008 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21009 (gdb)
21010 @end smallexample
21011
21012 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21013 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21014 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21015
21016 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21017
21018 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21019 @findex -gdb-exit
21020
21021 @subsubheading Synopsis
21022
21023 @smallexample
21024 -gdb-exit
21025 @end smallexample
21026
21027 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21028
21029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21030
21031 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21032
21033 @subsubheading Example
21034
21035 @smallexample
21036 (gdb)
21037 -gdb-exit
21038 ^exit
21039 @end smallexample
21040
21041
21042 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21043 @findex -exec-abort
21044
21045 @subsubheading Synopsis
21046
21047 @smallexample
21048 -exec-abort
21049 @end smallexample
21050
21051 Kill the inferior running program.
21052
21053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21054
21055 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21056
21057 @subsubheading Example
21058 N.A.
21059
21060
21061 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21062 @findex -gdb-set
21063
21064 @subsubheading Synopsis
21065
21066 @smallexample
21067 -gdb-set
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21071 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21072
21073 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21074
21075 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21076
21077 @subsubheading Example
21078
21079 @smallexample
21080 (gdb)
21081 -gdb-set $foo=3
21082 ^done
21083 (gdb)
21084 @end smallexample
21085
21086
21087 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21088 @findex -gdb-show
21089
21090 @subsubheading Synopsis
21091
21092 @smallexample
21093 -gdb-show
21094 @end smallexample
21095
21096 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21097
21098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21099
21100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21101
21102 @subsubheading Example
21103
21104 @smallexample
21105 (gdb)
21106 -gdb-show annotate
21107 ^done,value="0"
21108 (gdb)
21109 @end smallexample
21110
21111 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21112
21113
21114 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21115 @findex -gdb-version
21116
21117 @subsubheading Synopsis
21118
21119 @smallexample
21120 -gdb-version
21121 @end smallexample
21122
21123 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21124
21125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21126
21127 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21128 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21129
21130 @subsubheading Example
21131
21132 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21133 @c box in TeX.
21134 @smallexample
21135 (gdb)
21136 -gdb-version
21137 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21138 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21139 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21140 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21141 ~ certain conditions.
21142 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21143 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21144 ~ details.
21145 ~This GDB was configured as
21146 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21147 ^done
21148 (gdb)
21149 @end smallexample
21150
21151 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21152 @findex -interpreter-exec
21153
21154 @subheading Synopsis
21155
21156 @smallexample
21157 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21158 @end smallexample
21159 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21160
21161 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21162
21163 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21164
21165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21166
21167 @subheading Example
21168
21169 @smallexample
21170 (gdb)
21171 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21172 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21173 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21174 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21175 ^done
21176 (gdb)
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21180 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21181
21182 @subheading Synopsis
21183
21184 @smallexample
21185 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21186 @end smallexample
21187
21188 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21189
21190 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21191
21192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21193
21194 @subheading Example
21195
21196 @smallexample
21197 (gdb)
21198 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21199 ^done
21200 (gdb)
21201 @end smallexample
21202
21203 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21204 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21205
21206 @subheading Synopsis
21207
21208 @smallexample
21209 -inferior-tty-show
21210 @end smallexample
21211
21212 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21213
21214 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21215
21216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21217
21218 @subheading Example
21219
21220 @smallexample
21221 (gdb)
21222 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21223 ^done
21224 (gdb)
21225 -inferior-tty-show
21226 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21227 (gdb)
21228 @end smallexample
21229
21230 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21231 @findex -enable-timings
21232
21233 @subheading Synopsis
21234
21235 @smallexample
21236 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21237 @end smallexample
21238
21239 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21240 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21241 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21242 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21243
21244 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21245
21246 No equivalent.
21247
21248 @subheading Example
21249
21250 @smallexample
21251 (gdb)
21252 -enable-timings
21253 ^done
21254 (gdb)
21255 -break-insert main
21256 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21257 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21258 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21259 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21260 (gdb)
21261 -enable-timings no
21262 ^done
21263 (gdb)
21264 -exec-run
21265 ^running
21266 (gdb)
21267 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21268 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21269 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21270 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21271 (gdb)
21272 @end smallexample
21273
21274 @node Annotations
21275 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21276
21277 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21278 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21279 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21280 relatively high level.
21281
21282 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21283 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21284
21285 @ignore
21286 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21287 @end ignore
21288
21289 @menu
21290 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21291 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21292 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21293 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21294 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21295 * Annotations for Running::
21296 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21297 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21298 @end menu
21299
21300 @node Annotations Overview
21301 @section What is an Annotation?
21302 @cindex annotations
21303
21304 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21305 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21306 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21307 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21308 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21309 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21310 cannot contain newline characters.
21311
21312 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21313 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21314 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21315 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21316 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21317 means those three characters as output.
21318
21319 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21320 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21321 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21322 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21323 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21324 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21325 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21326 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21327 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21328
21329 @table @code
21330 @kindex set annotate
21331 @item set annotate @var{level}
21332 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21333 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21334
21335 @item show annotate
21336 @kindex show annotate
21337 Show the current annotation level.
21338 @end table
21339
21340 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21341
21342 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21343
21344 @smallexample
21345 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21346 GNU gdb 6.0
21347 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21348 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21349 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21350 under certain conditions.
21351 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21352 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21353 for details.
21354 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21355
21356 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21357 (@value{GDBP})
21358 ^Z^Zprompt
21359 @kbd{quit}
21360
21361 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21362 $
21363 @end smallexample
21364
21365 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21366 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21367 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21368 output from @value{GDBN}.
21369
21370 @node Server Prefix
21371 @section The Server Prefix
21372 @cindex server prefix
21373
21374 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21375 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21376 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21377 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21378 a transparent manner.
21379
21380 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21381 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21382 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21383
21384 @node Prompting
21385 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21386
21387 @cindex annotations for prompts
21388 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21389 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21390 over, etc.
21391
21392 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21393 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21394 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21395 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21396 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21397 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21398 features the following annotations:
21399
21400 @smallexample
21401 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21402 ^Z^Zprompt
21403 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21404 @end smallexample
21405
21406 The input types are
21407
21408 @table @code
21409 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21410 @findex prompt annotation
21411 @findex post-prompt annotation
21412 @item prompt
21413 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21414
21415 @findex pre-commands annotation
21416 @findex commands annotation
21417 @findex post-commands annotation
21418 @item commands
21419 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21420 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21421
21422 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21423 @findex overload-choice annotation
21424 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21425 @item overload-choice
21426 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21427
21428 @findex pre-query annotation
21429 @findex query annotation
21430 @findex post-query annotation
21431 @item query
21432 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21433
21434 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21435 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21436 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21437 @item prompt-for-continue
21438 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21439 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21440 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21441 presence of annotations.
21442 @end table
21443
21444 @node Errors
21445 @section Errors
21446 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21447
21448 @findex quit annotation
21449 @smallexample
21450 ^Z^Zquit
21451 @end smallexample
21452
21453 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21454
21455 @findex error annotation
21456 @smallexample
21457 ^Z^Zerror
21458 @end smallexample
21459
21460 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21461
21462 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21463 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21464 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21465 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21466 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21467 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21468 to the top level.
21469
21470 @findex error-begin annotation
21471 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21472
21473 @smallexample
21474 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21475 @end smallexample
21476
21477 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21478 message.
21479
21480 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21481 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21482 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21483
21484 @node Invalidation
21485 @section Invalidation Notices
21486
21487 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21488 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21489 changed.
21490
21491 @table @code
21492 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21493 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21494
21495 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21496 have changed.
21497
21498 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21499 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21500
21501 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21502 deleted a breakpoint.
21503 @end table
21504
21505 @node Annotations for Running
21506 @section Running the Program
21507 @cindex annotations for running programs
21508
21509 @findex starting annotation
21510 @findex stopping annotation
21511 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21512 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21513
21514 @smallexample
21515 ^Z^Zstarting
21516 @end smallexample
21517
21518 is output. When the program stops,
21519
21520 @smallexample
21521 ^Z^Zstopped
21522 @end smallexample
21523
21524 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21525 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21526
21527 @table @code
21528 @findex exited annotation
21529 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21530 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21531 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21532
21533 @findex signalled annotation
21534 @findex signal-name annotation
21535 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21536 @findex signal-string annotation
21537 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21538 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21539 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21540 annotation continues:
21541
21542 @smallexample
21543 @var{intro-text}
21544 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21545 @var{name}
21546 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21547 @var{middle-text}
21548 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21549 @var{string}
21550 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21551 @var{end-text}
21552 @end smallexample
21553
21554 @noindent
21555 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21556 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21557 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21558 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21559 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21560
21561 @findex signal annotation
21562 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21563 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21564 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21565 terminated with it.
21566
21567 @findex breakpoint annotation
21568 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21569 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21570
21571 @findex watchpoint annotation
21572 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21573 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21574 @end table
21575
21576 @node Source Annotations
21577 @section Displaying Source
21578 @cindex annotations for source display
21579
21580 @findex source annotation
21581 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21582
21583 @smallexample
21584 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21585 @end smallexample
21586
21587 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21588 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21589 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21590 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21591 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21592 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21593 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21594 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21595 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21596 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21597 depend on the language).
21598
21599 @node GDB Bugs
21600 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21601 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21602 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21603
21604 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21605
21606 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21607 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21608 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21609 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21610
21611 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21612 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21613
21614 @menu
21615 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21616 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21617 @end menu
21618
21619 @node Bug Criteria
21620 @section Have You Found a Bug?
21621 @cindex bug criteria
21622
21623 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21624
21625 @itemize @bullet
21626 @cindex fatal signal
21627 @cindex debugger crash
21628 @cindex crash of debugger
21629 @item
21630 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21631 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21632
21633 @cindex error on valid input
21634 @item
21635 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21636 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21637 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21638
21639 @cindex invalid input
21640 @item
21641 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21642 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21643 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21644 for traditional practice''.
21645
21646 @item
21647 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21648 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21649 @end itemize
21650
21651 @node Bug Reporting
21652 @section How to Report Bugs
21653 @cindex bug reports
21654 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21655
21656 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21657 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21658 contact that organization first.
21659
21660 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21661 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21662 distribution.
21663 @c should add a web page ref...
21664
21665 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21666 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21667 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21668 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21669 be used.
21670
21671 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21672 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21673 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21674 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21675
21676 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21677 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21678 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21679 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21680 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21681 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21682 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21683 bug reports to the mailing list.
21684
21685 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21686 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21687 fact or leave it out, state it!
21688
21689 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21690 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21691 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21692 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21693 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21694 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21695 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21696 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21697 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21698
21699 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21700 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21701 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21702 self-contained.
21703
21704 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21705 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21706 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21707 bugs properly.
21708
21709 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21710
21711 @itemize @bullet
21712 @item
21713 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21714 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21715 version}.
21716
21717 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21718 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21719
21720 @item
21721 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21722 version number.
21723
21724 @item
21725 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21726 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21727
21728 @item
21729 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21730 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21731 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
21732 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
21733 those compilers.
21734
21735 @item
21736 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21737 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21738 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21739 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21740
21741 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21742 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21743
21744 @item
21745 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21746 reproduce the bug.
21747
21748 @item
21749 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21750 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21751
21752 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21753 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21754 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21755 a chance to make a mistake.
21756
21757 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21758 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21759 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21760 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21761 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21762 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21763 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21764 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21765
21766 @pindex script
21767 @cindex recording a session script
21768 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21769 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21770 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21771 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21772
21773 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21774 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21775
21776 @item
21777 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21778 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21779 it by context, not by line number.
21780
21781 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21782 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21783
21784 @end itemize
21785
21786 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21787
21788 @itemize @bullet
21789 @item
21790 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21791
21792 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21793 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21794 changes will not affect it.
21795
21796 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21797 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21798 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21799 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21800
21801 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21802 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21803 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21804 less time, and so on.
21805
21806 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21807 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21808
21809 @item
21810 A patch for the bug.
21811
21812 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21813 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21814 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21815 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21816
21817 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21818 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21819 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21820 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21821
21822 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21823 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21824 help us to understand.
21825
21826 @item
21827 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21828
21829 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21830 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21831 @end itemize
21832
21833 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21834 @c and consists of the two following files:
21835 @c rluser.texinfo
21836 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21837 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21838 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21839 @include rluser.texi
21840 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21841
21842
21843 @node Formatting Documentation
21844 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21845
21846 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21847 @cindex reference card
21848 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21849 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21850 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21851 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21852 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21853 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21854
21855 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21856 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21857
21858 @smallexample
21859 make refcard.dvi
21860 @end smallexample
21861
21862 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21863 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21864 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21865 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21866 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21867
21868 @cindex documentation
21869
21870 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21871 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21872 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21873 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21874 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21875 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21876
21877 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21878 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21879 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21880 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21881 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21882 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21883 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21884 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21885
21886 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21887 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21888 @code{makeinfo}.
21889
21890 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21891 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21892 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21893
21894 @smallexample
21895 cd gdb
21896 make gdb.info
21897 @end smallexample
21898
21899 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21900 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21901 Texinfo definitions file.
21902
21903 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21904 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21905 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21906 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21907 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21908 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21909 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21910
21911 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21912 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21913 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21914 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21915 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21916 directory.
21917
21918 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21919 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
21920 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21921 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21922
21923 @smallexample
21924 make gdb.dvi
21925 @end smallexample
21926
21927 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21928
21929 @node Installing GDB
21930 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21931 @cindex installation
21932
21933 @menu
21934 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
21935 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
21936 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21937 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21938 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21939 @end menu
21940
21941 @node Requirements
21942 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
21943 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
21944
21945 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
21946 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
21947
21948 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
21949 @table @asis
21950 @item ISO C90 compiler
21951 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
21952 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
21953
21954 @end table
21955
21956 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
21957 @table @asis
21958 @item Expat
21959 @anchor{Expat}
21960 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
21961 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
21962 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
21963 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
21964 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
21965 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
21966
21967 Expat is used for remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
21968 and for target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}).
21969
21970 @end table
21971
21972 @node Running Configure
21973 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
21974 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21975 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
21976 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21977 build the @code{gdb} program.
21978 @iftex
21979 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21980 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21981 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21982 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21983 @end iftex
21984
21985 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21986 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21987 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21988
21989 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21990 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21991
21992 @table @code
21993 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21994 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21995
21996 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21997 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21998
21999 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22000 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22001
22002 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22003 @sc{gnu} include files
22004
22005 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22006 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22007
22008 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22009 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22010
22011 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22012 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22013
22014 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22015 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22016
22017 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22018 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22019 @end table
22020
22021 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22022 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22023 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22024
22025 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22026 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22027 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22028 argument.
22029
22030 For example:
22031
22032 @smallexample
22033 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22034 ./configure @var{host}
22035 make
22036 @end smallexample
22037
22038 @noindent
22039 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22040 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22041 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22042 correct value by examining your system.)
22043
22044 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22045 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22046 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22047 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22048
22049 @need 750
22050 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22051 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22052 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22053
22054 @smallexample
22055 sh configure @var{host}
22056 @end smallexample
22057
22058 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22059 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22060 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22061 @file{configure}
22062 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22063 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22064
22065 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22066 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22067 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22068 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22069 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22070 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22071 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22072 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22073 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22074
22075 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22076 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22077 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22078 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22079 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22080
22081 @node Separate Objdir
22082 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22083
22084 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22085 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22086 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22087 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22088 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22089 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22090 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22091 program specified there.
22092
22093 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22094 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22095 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22096 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22097 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22098 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22099
22100 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22101 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22102
22103 @smallexample
22104 @group
22105 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22106 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22107 cd ../gdb-sun4
22108 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22109 make
22110 @end group
22111 @end smallexample
22112
22113 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22114 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22115 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22116 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22117 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22118 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22119
22120 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22121 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22122 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22123 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22124 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22125
22126 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22127 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22128 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22129 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22130 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22131 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22132
22133 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22134 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22135 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22136
22137 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22138 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22139 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22140 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22141 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22142
22143 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22144 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22145 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22146 with each other.
22147
22148 @node Config Names
22149 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22150
22151 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22152 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22153 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22154 of information in the following pattern:
22155
22156 @smallexample
22157 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22158 @end smallexample
22159
22160 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22161 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22162 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22163
22164 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22165 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22166 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22167 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22168 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22169 abbreviations---for example:
22170
22171 @smallexample
22172 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22173 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22174 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22175 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22176 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22177 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22178 % sh config.sub sun4
22179 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22180 % sh config.sub sun3
22181 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22182 % sh config.sub i986v
22183 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22184 @end smallexample
22185
22186 @noindent
22187 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22188 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22189
22190 @node Configure Options
22191 @section @file{configure} Options
22192
22193 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22194 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22195 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22196 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22197
22198 @smallexample
22199 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22200 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22201 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22202 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22203 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22204 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22205 @var{host}
22206 @end smallexample
22207
22208 @noindent
22209 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22210 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22211 @samp{--}.
22212
22213 @table @code
22214 @item --help
22215 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22216
22217 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22218 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22219 @file{@var{dir}}.
22220
22221 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22222 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22223 @file{@var{dir}}.
22224
22225 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22226 @need 2000
22227 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22228 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22229 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22230 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22231 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22232 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22233 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22234 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22235 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22236 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22237 @var{dirname}.
22238
22239 @item --norecursion
22240 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22241 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22242
22243 @item --target=@var{target}
22244 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22245 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22246 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22247
22248 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22249
22250 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22251 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22252
22253 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22254 @end table
22255
22256 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22257 needed for special purposes only.
22258
22259 @node Maintenance Commands
22260 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22261 @cindex maintenance commands
22262 @cindex internal commands
22263
22264 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22265 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22266 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22267 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22268 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22269
22270 @table @code
22271 @kindex maint agent
22272 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22273 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22274 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22275 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22276
22277 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22278 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22279 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22280 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22281 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22282 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22283 is shown:
22284
22285 @table @code
22286 @item breakpoint
22287 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22288
22289 @item watchpoint
22290 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22291
22292 @item longjmp
22293 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22294 @code{longjmp} calls.
22295
22296 @item longjmp resume
22297 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22298
22299 @item until
22300 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22301
22302 @item finish
22303 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22304
22305 @item shlib events
22306 Shared library events.
22307
22308 @end table
22309
22310 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22311 @item maint check-symtabs
22312 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22313
22314 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22315 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22316 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22317
22318 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22319 @item maint cplus namespace
22320 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22321
22322 @kindex maint demangle
22323 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22324 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22325
22326 @kindex maint deprecate
22327 @kindex maint undeprecate
22328 @cindex deprecated commands
22329 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22330 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22331 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22332 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22333 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22334 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22335 the replacement as part of the warning.
22336
22337 @kindex maint dump-me
22338 @item maint dump-me
22339 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22340 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22341 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22342 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22343
22344 @kindex maint internal-error
22345 @kindex maint internal-warning
22346 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22347 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22348 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22349 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22350 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22351 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22352 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22353 @value{GDBN} session.
22354
22355 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22356 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22357
22358 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22359
22360 @smallexample
22361 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22362 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22363 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22364 debugging may prove unreliable.
22365 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22366 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22367 (@value{GDBP})
22368 @end smallexample
22369
22370 @kindex maint packet
22371 @item maint packet @var{text}
22372 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22373 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22374 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22375 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22376 checksum.
22377
22378 @kindex maint print architecture
22379 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22380 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22381 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22382
22383 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22384 @item maint print dummy-frames
22385 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22386
22387 @smallexample
22388 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22389 @dots{}
22390 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22391 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22392 58 return (a + b);
22393 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22394 @dots{}
22395 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22396 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22397 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22398 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22399 (@value{GDBP})
22400 @end smallexample
22401
22402 Takes an optional file parameter.
22403
22404 @kindex maint print registers
22405 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22406 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22407 @kindex maint print register-groups
22408 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22409 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22410 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22411 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22412 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22413
22414 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22415 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22416 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22417 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22418 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22419 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22420
22421 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22422 write the information.
22423
22424 @kindex maint print reggroups
22425 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22426 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22427 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22428 information.
22429
22430 The register groups info looks like this:
22431
22432 @smallexample
22433 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22434 Group Type
22435 general user
22436 float user
22437 all user
22438 vector user
22439 system user
22440 save internal
22441 restore internal
22442 @end smallexample
22443
22444 @kindex flushregs
22445 @item flushregs
22446 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22447
22448 @kindex maint print objfiles
22449 @cindex info for known object files
22450 @item maint print objfiles
22451 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22452 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22453 and symtabs.
22454
22455 @kindex maint print statistics
22456 @cindex bcache statistics
22457 @item maint print statistics
22458 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22459 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22460 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22461 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22462 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22463 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22464 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22465 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22466 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22467 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22468 lengths.
22469
22470 @kindex maint print target-stack
22471 @cindex target stack description
22472 @item maint print target-stack
22473 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22474 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22475 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22476 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22477 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22478 address.
22479
22480 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22481 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22482
22483 @kindex maint print type
22484 @cindex type chain of a data type
22485 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22486 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22487 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22488 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22489 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22490 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22491
22492 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22493 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22494 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22495 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22496 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22497
22498 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22499 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22500 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22501 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22502 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22503 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22504 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22505 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22506 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22507
22508 @kindex maint set profile
22509 @kindex maint show profile
22510 @cindex profiling GDB
22511 @item maint set profile
22512 @itemx maint show profile
22513 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22514
22515 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22516 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22517 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22518 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22519 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22520 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22521 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22522
22523 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22524 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22525
22526 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22527 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22528 @item maint show-debug-regs
22529 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22530 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22531 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
22532 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22533 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22534
22535 @kindex maint space
22536 @cindex memory used by commands
22537 @item maint space
22538 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22539 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22540 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22541 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22542 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22543
22544 @kindex maint time
22545 @cindex time of command execution
22546 @item maint time
22547 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22548 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22549 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22550 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22551 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22552
22553 @kindex maint translate-address
22554 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22555 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22556 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22557 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22558 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22559 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22560 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22561
22562 @end table
22563
22564 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22565 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22566
22567 @table @code
22568 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22569 @kindex set watchdog
22570 @cindex watchdog timer
22571 @cindex timeout for commands
22572 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22573 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22574 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22575
22576 @item show watchdog
22577 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22578 @end table
22579
22580 @node Remote Protocol
22581 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22582
22583 @menu
22584 * Overview::
22585 * Packets::
22586 * Stop Reply Packets::
22587 * General Query Packets::
22588 * Register Packet Format::
22589 * Tracepoint Packets::
22590 * Interrupts::
22591 * Examples::
22592 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
22593 * Library List Format::
22594 * Memory Map Format::
22595 @end menu
22596
22597 @node Overview
22598 @section Overview
22599
22600 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22601 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22602 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22603 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22604
22605 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22606 transmitted and received data, respectively.
22607
22608 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22609 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22610 @cindex remote serial protocol
22611 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22612 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22613 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22614 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22615
22616 @smallexample
22617 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22618 @end smallexample
22619 @noindent
22620
22621 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22622 @noindent
22623 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22624 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22625 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22626
22627 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22628 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22629
22630 @smallexample
22631 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22632 @end smallexample
22633
22634 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22635 @noindent
22636 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22637 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22638 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22639
22640 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22641 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22642 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22643 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22644 retransmission):
22645
22646 @smallexample
22647 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22648 <- @code{+}
22649 @end smallexample
22650 @noindent
22651
22652 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22653 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22654 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22655 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22656
22657 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22658 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22659 exceptions).
22660
22661 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22662 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22663 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22664 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22665
22666 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22667 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22668 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22669
22670 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22671 @anchor{Binary Data}
22672 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22673 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22674 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22675 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22676 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22677 binary data.
22678
22679 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22680 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22681 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22682 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22683 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22684 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22685 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22686 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22687 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22688 (described next).
22689
22690 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22691 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22692 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22693 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22694 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22695 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22696 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22697
22698 So:
22699 @smallexample
22700 "@code{0* }"
22701 @end smallexample
22702 @noindent
22703 means the same as "0000".
22704
22705 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22706 error number. That number is not well defined.
22707
22708 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22709 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22710 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22711 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22712 on that response.
22713
22714 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22715 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22716 optional.
22717
22718 @node Packets
22719 @section Packets
22720
22721 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22722 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22723 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
22724 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22725
22726 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22727 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22728 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22729 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22730 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22731 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22732 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22733 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
22734 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22735 @var{baz}.
22736
22737 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22738 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22739
22740 Here are the packet descriptions.
22741
22742 @table @samp
22743
22744 @item !
22745 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22746 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22747 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22748 debugged.
22749
22750 Reply:
22751 @table @samp
22752 @item OK
22753 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22754 @end table
22755
22756 @item ?
22757 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22758 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22759 step and continue.
22760
22761 Reply:
22762 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22763
22764 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22765 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22766 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22767 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22768 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22769
22770 Reply:
22771 @table @samp
22772 @item OK
22773 The arguments were set.
22774 @item E @var{NN}
22775 An error occurred.
22776 @end table
22777
22778 @item b @var{baud}
22779 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22780 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22781 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22782
22783 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22784 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22785 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22786
22787 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22788 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22789 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22790 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22791 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22792
22793 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22794 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22795 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22796 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22797
22798 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22799 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22800
22801 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22802 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22803 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22804 resume at current address.
22805
22806 Reply:
22807 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22808
22809 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22810 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22811 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22812 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22813
22814 Reply:
22815 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22816
22817 @item d
22818 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22819 Toggle debug flag.
22820
22821 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22822 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22823
22824 @item D
22825 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22826 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22827 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22828
22829 Reply:
22830 @table @samp
22831 @item OK
22832 for success
22833 @item E @var{NN}
22834 for an error
22835 @end table
22836
22837 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22838 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22839 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22840 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22841 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
22842
22843 @item g
22844 @anchor{read registers packet}
22845 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22846 Read general registers.
22847
22848 Reply:
22849 @table @samp
22850 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22851 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22852 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22853 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22854 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
22855 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
22856 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22857 @item E @var{NN}
22858 for an error.
22859 @end table
22860
22861 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22862 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22863 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22864 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22865
22866 Reply:
22867 @table @samp
22868 @item OK
22869 for success
22870 @item E @var{NN}
22871 for an error
22872 @end table
22873
22874 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22875 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22876 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22877 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22878 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22879 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22880 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22881
22882 Reply:
22883 @table @samp
22884 @item OK
22885 for success
22886 @item E @var{NN}
22887 for an error
22888 @end table
22889
22890 @c FIXME: JTC:
22891 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22892 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22893 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22894 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22895 @c described. For example:
22896 @c
22897 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22898 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22899 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22900 @c
22901 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22902 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22903 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22904
22905 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22906 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22907 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22908 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22909 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22910 step starting at that address.
22911
22912 @item I
22913 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22914 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22915 step packet}.
22916
22917 @item k
22918 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22919 Kill request.
22920
22921 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22922 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22923 thread?)}.
22924
22925 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22926 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22927 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22928 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22929
22930 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22931 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22932 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22933 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22934 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22935 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22936 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22937 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22938
22939 Reply:
22940 @table @samp
22941 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22942 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
22943 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22944 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22945 @item E @var{NN}
22946 @var{NN} is errno
22947 @end table
22948
22949 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22950 @cindex @samp{M} packet
22951 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22952 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22953 hexadecimal number.
22954
22955 Reply:
22956 @table @samp
22957 @item OK
22958 for success
22959 @item E @var{NN}
22960 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22961 written).
22962 @end table
22963
22964 @item p @var{n}
22965 @cindex @samp{p} packet
22966 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22967 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22968 register value is encoded.
22969
22970 Reply:
22971 @table @samp
22972 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22973 the register's value
22974 @item E @var{NN}
22975 for an error
22976 @item
22977 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22978 @end table
22979
22980 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22981 @anchor{write register packet}
22982 @cindex @samp{P} packet
22983 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22984 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22985 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22986
22987 Reply:
22988 @table @samp
22989 @item OK
22990 for success
22991 @item E @var{NN}
22992 for an error
22993 @end table
22994
22995 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22996 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22997 @cindex @samp{q} packet
22998 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
22999 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23000 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23001
23002 @item r
23003 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23004 Reset the entire system.
23005
23006 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23007
23008 @item R @var{XX}
23009 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23010 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23011 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23012
23013 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23014
23015 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23016 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23017 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23018 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23019
23020 Reply:
23021 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23022
23023 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23024 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23025 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23026 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23027 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23028
23029 Reply:
23030 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23031
23032 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23033 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23034 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23035 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23036 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23037
23038 @item T @var{XX}
23039 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23040 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23041
23042 Reply:
23043 @table @samp
23044 @item OK
23045 thread is still alive
23046 @item E @var{NN}
23047 thread is dead
23048 @end table
23049
23050 @item v
23051 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23052 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23053
23054 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23055 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23056 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23057 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23058 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23059 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23060 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23061 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23062
23063 @table @samp
23064 @item c
23065 Continue.
23066 @item C @var{sig}
23067 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23068 @item s
23069 Step.
23070 @item S @var{sig}
23071 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23072 @end table
23073
23074 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23075 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23076
23077 Reply:
23078 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23079
23080 @item vCont?
23081 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23082 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23083
23084 Reply:
23085 @table @samp
23086 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23087 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23088 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23089 @item
23090 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23091 @end table
23092
23093 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23094 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23095 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23096 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23097 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23098 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23099 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23100 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23101 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23102 packet is received.
23103
23104 Reply:
23105 @table @samp
23106 @item OK
23107 for success
23108 @item E @var{NN}
23109 for an error
23110 @end table
23111
23112 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23113 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23114 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23115 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23116 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23117 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23118 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23119 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23120 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23121 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23122 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23123 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23124
23125
23126 Reply:
23127 @table @samp
23128 @item OK
23129 for success
23130 @item E.memtype
23131 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23132 @item E @var{NN}
23133 for an error
23134 @end table
23135
23136 @item vFlashDone
23137 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23138 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23139 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23140 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23141 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23142 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23143 request is completed.
23144
23145 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23146 @anchor{X packet}
23147 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23148 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23149 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23150 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23151
23152 Reply:
23153 @table @samp
23154 @item OK
23155 for success
23156 @item E @var{NN}
23157 for an error
23158 @end table
23159
23160 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23161 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23162 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23163 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23164 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23165 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23166 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23167 @var{length} bytes.
23168
23169 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23170 separately.
23171
23172 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23173 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23174 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23175 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23176 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23177 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23178
23179 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23180 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23181 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23182 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23183 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23184 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23185
23186 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23187 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23188 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23189 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23190 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23191
23192 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23193 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23194 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23195 target, is not defined.}
23196
23197 Reply:
23198 @table @samp
23199 @item OK
23200 success
23201 @item
23202 not supported
23203 @item E @var{NN}
23204 for an error
23205 @end table
23206
23207 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23208 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23209 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23210 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23211 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23212 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23213
23214 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23215 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23216
23217 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23218 movement.}
23219
23220 Reply:
23221 @table @samp
23222 @item OK
23223 success
23224 @item
23225 not supported
23226 @item E @var{NN}
23227 for an error
23228 @end table
23229
23230 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23231 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23232 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23233 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23234 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23235
23236 Reply:
23237 @table @samp
23238 @item OK
23239 success
23240 @item
23241 not supported
23242 @item E @var{NN}
23243 for an error
23244 @end table
23245
23246 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23247 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23248 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23249 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23250 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23251
23252 Reply:
23253 @table @samp
23254 @item OK
23255 success
23256 @item
23257 not supported
23258 @item E @var{NN}
23259 for an error
23260 @end table
23261
23262 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23263 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23264 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23265 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23266 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23267
23268 Reply:
23269 @table @samp
23270 @item OK
23271 success
23272 @item
23273 not supported
23274 @item E @var{NN}
23275 for an error
23276 @end table
23277
23278 @end table
23279
23280 @node Stop Reply Packets
23281 @section Stop Reply Packets
23282 @cindex stop reply packets
23283
23284 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23285 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23286 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23287 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23288 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23289 @value{GDBN} source code.
23290
23291 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23292 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23293 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23294 components.
23295
23296 @table @samp
23297
23298 @item S @var{AA}
23299 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23300 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23301 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23302
23303 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23304 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23305 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23306 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23307 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23308 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23309 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23310 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23311
23312 @itemize @bullet
23313 @item
23314 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23315 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23316 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23317 two-digit hex number.
23318
23319 @item
23320 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23321 hex.
23322
23323 @item
23324 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23325 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23326 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23327 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23328
23329 @item
23330 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23331 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23332 future.
23333 @end itemize
23334
23335 The currently defined stop reasons are:
23336
23337 @table @samp
23338 @item watch
23339 @itemx rwatch
23340 @itemx awatch
23341 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23342 hex.
23343
23344 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
23345 @item library
23346 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23347 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23348 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23349 @end table
23350
23351 @item W @var{AA}
23352 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23353 applicable to certain targets.
23354
23355 @item X @var{AA}
23356 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23357
23358 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23359 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23360 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23361 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23362 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23363
23364 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23365 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23366 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23367 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23368 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23369 system calls.
23370
23371 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23372 this very system call.
23373
23374 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23375 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23376 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23377 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23378 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23379 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23380
23381 @end table
23382
23383 @node General Query Packets
23384 @section General Query Packets
23385 @cindex remote query requests
23386
23387 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23388 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23389 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23390 sending information to and from the stub.
23391
23392 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23393 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23394 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23395 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23396 conventions:
23397
23398 @itemize @bullet
23399 @item
23400 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23401 @item
23402 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23403 letter.
23404 @item
23405 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23406 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23407 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23408 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23409 @end itemize
23410
23411 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23412 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23413 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23414 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23415 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23416 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23417 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23418 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23419 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23420 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23421 packet.}.
23422
23423 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23424 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23425 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23426 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23427 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23428
23429 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23430
23431 @table @samp
23432
23433 @item qC
23434 @cindex current thread, remote request
23435 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23436 Return the current thread id.
23437
23438 Reply:
23439 @table @samp
23440 @item QC @var{pid}
23441 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23442 @item @r{(anything else)}
23443 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23444 @end table
23445
23446 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23447 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23448 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23449 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23450 Reply:
23451 @table @samp
23452 @item E @var{NN}
23453 An error (such as memory fault)
23454 @item C @var{crc32}
23455 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23456 @end table
23457
23458 @item qfThreadInfo
23459 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23460 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23461 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23462 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23463 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23464 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23465 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23466 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23467 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23468 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23469
23470 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23471
23472 Reply:
23473 @table @samp
23474 @item m @var{id}
23475 A single thread id
23476 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23477 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23478 @item l
23479 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23480 @end table
23481
23482 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23483 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23484 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23485 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23486 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23487
23488 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23489 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23490 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23491 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23492 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23493
23494 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23495 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23496
23497 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23498 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23499 information associated with the variable.)
23500
23501 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
23502 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23503 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23504 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23505 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23506 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23507
23508 Reply:
23509 @table @samp
23510 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23511 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23512 local storage requested.
23513
23514 @item E @var{nn}
23515 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23516
23517 @item
23518 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23519 @end table
23520
23521 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23522 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23523 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23524 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23525 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23526 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23527 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23528
23529 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23530
23531 Reply:
23532 @table @samp
23533 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23534 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23535 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23536 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23537 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23538 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23539 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23540 @end table
23541
23542 @item qOffsets
23543 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23544 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23545 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
23546 image.
23547
23548 Reply:
23549 @table @samp
23550 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
23551 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
23552 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
23553 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
23554 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
23555 segments by the supplied offsets.
23556
23557 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
23558 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
23559 to the @code{Bss} section.}
23560
23561 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
23562 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
23563 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
23564 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
23565 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
23566 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
23567 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
23568 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
23569 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
23570 @end table
23571
23572 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23573 @cindex thread information, remote request
23574 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23575 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23576 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23577
23578 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23579 (see below).
23580
23581 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23582
23583 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23584 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23585 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23586 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23587 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23588 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23589 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23590 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23591 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23592 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23593 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23594 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23595 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23596
23597 Reply:
23598 @table @samp
23599 @item OK
23600 The request succeeded.
23601
23602 @item E @var{nn}
23603 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23604
23605 @item
23606 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23607 the stub.
23608 @end table
23609
23610 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23611 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23612 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23613 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23614
23615 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23616 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23617 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23618 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23619 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23620 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23621 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23622 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23623 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23624
23625 Reply:
23626 @table @samp
23627 @item OK
23628 A command response with no output.
23629 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23630 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23631 @item E @var{NN}
23632 Indicate a badly formed request.
23633 @item
23634 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23635 @end table
23636
23637 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23638 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23639 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23640 packets.)
23641
23642 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23643 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23644 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23645 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23646 @anchor{qSupported}
23647 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23648 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23649 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23650 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23651 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23652 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23653 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23654 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23655 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23656 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23657 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23658 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23659 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23660 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23661
23662 Reply:
23663 @table @samp
23664 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23665 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23666 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23667 possible forms).
23668 @item
23669 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23670 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23671 @end table
23672
23673 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23674 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23675 are:
23676
23677 @table @samp
23678 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23679 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23680 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23681 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23682 @item @var{name}+
23683 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23684 need an associated value.
23685 @item @var{name}-
23686 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23687 @item @var{name}?
23688 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23689 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23690 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23691 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23692 @end table
23693
23694 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23695 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23696 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23697 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23698 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23699
23700 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23701 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23702 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23703 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23704 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23705 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23706 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23707 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23708 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23709 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23710 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23711 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23712 all the features it supports.
23713
23714 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23715 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23716
23717 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23718 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23719 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23720 form response.
23721
23722 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23723 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23724 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23725 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23726
23727 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23728 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23729 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23730 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23731 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23732
23733 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23734
23735 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
23736 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23737 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23738 @item Feature Name
23739 @tab Value Required
23740 @tab Default
23741 @tab Probe Allowed
23742
23743 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23744 @tab Yes
23745 @tab @samp{-}
23746 @tab No
23747
23748 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23749 @tab No
23750 @tab @samp{-}
23751 @tab Yes
23752
23753 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
23754 @tab No
23755 @tab @samp{-}
23756 @tab Yes
23757
23758 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
23759 @tab No
23760 @tab @samp{-}
23761 @tab Yes
23762
23763 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23764 @tab No
23765 @tab @samp{-}
23766 @tab Yes
23767
23768 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
23769 @tab No
23770 @tab @samp{-}
23771 @tab Yes
23772
23773 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
23774 @tab No
23775 @tab @samp{-}
23776 @tab Yes
23777
23778 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23779 @tab No
23780 @tab @samp{-}
23781 @tab Yes
23782
23783 @end multitable
23784
23785 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23786
23787 @table @samp
23788 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23789 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23790 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23791 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23792 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23793 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23794 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23795 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23796 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23797 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23798
23799 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23800 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23801 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23802
23803 @item qXfer:features:read
23804 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
23805 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
23806
23807 @item qXfer:libraries:read
23808 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
23809 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
23810
23811 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
23812 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
23813 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
23814
23815 @item qXfer:spu:read
23816 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
23817 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
23818
23819 @item qXfer:spu:write
23820 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
23821 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
23822
23823 @item QPassSignals
23824 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23825 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
23826
23827 @end table
23828
23829 @item qSymbol::
23830 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23831 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23832 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23833 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23834
23835 Reply:
23836 @table @samp
23837 @item OK
23838 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23839 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23840 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23841 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23842 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23843 below.
23844 @end table
23845
23846 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23847 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23848
23849 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23850 target has previously requested.
23851
23852 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23853 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23854 will be empty.
23855
23856 Reply:
23857 @table @samp
23858 @item OK
23859 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23860 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23861 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23862 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23863 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23864 @end table
23865
23866 @item QTDP
23867 @itemx QTFrame
23868 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23869
23870 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23871 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23872 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23873 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23874 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23875 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23876 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23877 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23878 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23879 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23880
23881 Reply:
23882 @table @samp
23883 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23884 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23885 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23886 the thread's attributes.
23887 @end table
23888
23889 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23890 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23891 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23892 packets.)
23893
23894 @item QTStart
23895 @itemx QTStop
23896 @itemx QTinit
23897 @itemx QTro
23898 @itemx qTStatus
23899 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23900
23901 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23902 @cindex read special object, remote request
23903 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23904 @anchor{qXfer read}
23905 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23906 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23907 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23908 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
23909 additional details about what data to access.
23910
23911 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23912 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23913 formats, listed below.
23914
23915 @table @samp
23916 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23917 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23918 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23919 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23920
23921 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23922 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23923
23924 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23925 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
23926 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
23927 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
23928 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
23929
23930 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23931 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23932
23933 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23934 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
23935 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
23936 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23937 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23938
23939 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
23940 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
23941 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
23942
23943 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23944 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23945
23946 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23947 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23948 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
23949 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23950 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23951
23952 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23953 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23954
23955 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23956 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
23957 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
23958 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
23959 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
23960 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
23961 in that context to be accessed.
23962
23963 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23964 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23965 @end table
23966
23967 Reply:
23968 @table @samp
23969 @item m @var{data}
23970 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23971 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23972 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23973 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23974 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23975 request.
23976
23977 @item l @var{data}
23978 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23979 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23980 than the @var{length} in the request.
23981
23982 @item l
23983 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23984 There is no more data to be read.
23985
23986 @item E00
23987 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23988
23989 @item E @var{nn}
23990 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23991 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23992
23993 @item
23994 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23995 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23996 @end table
23997
23998 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23999 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24000 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24001 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24002 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24003 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24004 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24005 to access.
24006
24007 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24008 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24009 formats, listed below.
24010
24011 @table @samp
24012 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24013 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24014 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24015 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24016 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24017 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24018 in that context to be accessed.
24019
24020 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24021 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24022 @end table
24023
24024 Reply:
24025 @table @samp
24026 @item @var{nn}
24027 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24028 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24029
24030 @item E00
24031 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24032
24033 @item E @var{nn}
24034 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24035 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24036
24037 @item
24038 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24039 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24040 @end table
24041
24042 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24043 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24044 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24045 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24046 must respond with an empty packet.
24047
24048 @end table
24049
24050 @node Register Packet Format
24051 @section Register Packet Format
24052
24053 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24054 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24055 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24056 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24057 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24058 most-significant - least-significant.
24059
24060 @table @r
24061
24062 @item MIPS32
24063
24064 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24065 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24066 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24067
24068 @item MIPS64
24069
24070 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24071 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24072 as @code{MIPS32}.
24073
24074 @end table
24075
24076 @node Tracepoint Packets
24077 @section Tracepoint Packets
24078 @cindex tracepoint packets
24079 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24080
24081 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24082 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24083
24084 @table @samp
24085
24086 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24087 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24088 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24089 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24090 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24091 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24092 tracepoint's actions.
24093
24094 Replies:
24095 @table @samp
24096 @item OK
24097 The packet was understood and carried out.
24098 @item
24099 The packet was not recognized.
24100 @end table
24101
24102 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24103 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24104 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24105 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24106 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24107 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24108 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24109
24110 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24111 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24112 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24113 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24114 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24115 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24116 tracepoint actions.
24117
24118 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24119 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24120 following forms:
24121
24122 @table @samp
24123
24124 @item R @var{mask}
24125 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24126 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24127 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24128 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24129 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24130
24131 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24132 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24133 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24134 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24135 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24136 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24137 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24138
24139 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24140 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24141 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24142 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24143 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24144 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24145 packet).
24146
24147 @end table
24148
24149 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24150 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24151 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24152 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24153 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24154 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24155 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24156 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24157
24158 Replies:
24159 @table @samp
24160 @item OK
24161 The packet was understood and carried out.
24162 @item
24163 The packet was not recognized.
24164 @end table
24165
24166 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24167 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24168 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24169 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24170
24171 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24172 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24173 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24174 one of the following forms:
24175
24176 @table @samp
24177 @item F @var{f}
24178 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24179 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24180 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24181
24182 @item T @var{t}
24183 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24184 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24185
24186 @end table
24187
24188 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24189 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24190 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24191 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24192
24193 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24194 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24195 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24196 is a hexadecimal number.
24197
24198 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24199 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24200 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24201 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24202 numbers.
24203
24204 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24205 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24206 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24207
24208 @item QTStart
24209 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24210 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24211
24212 @item QTStop
24213 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24214
24215 @item QTinit
24216 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24217
24218 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24219 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24220 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24221 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24222
24223 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24224 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24225 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24226 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24227
24228 @item qTStatus
24229 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24230
24231 Replies:
24232 @table @samp
24233 @item T0
24234 There is no trace experiment running.
24235 @item T1
24236 There is a trace experiment running.
24237 @end table
24238
24239 @end table
24240
24241
24242 @node Interrupts
24243 @section Interrupts
24244 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24245
24246 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24247 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24248 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24249 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24250
24251 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24252 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24253 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24254 interfaces.
24255
24256 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24257 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24258 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24259 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24260 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24261 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24262 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24263 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24264
24265 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24266 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24267 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24268 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24269 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24270 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24271 program is stopped will be discarded.
24272
24273 @node Examples
24274 @section Examples
24275
24276 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24277 does not get any direct output:
24278
24279 @smallexample
24280 -> @code{R00}
24281 <- @code{+}
24282 @emph{target restarts}
24283 -> @code{?}
24284 <- @code{+}
24285 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24286 -> @code{+}
24287 @end smallexample
24288
24289 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24290
24291 @smallexample
24292 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24293 <- @code{+}
24294 -> @code{s}
24295 <- @code{+}
24296 @emph{time passes}
24297 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24298 -> @code{+}
24299 -> @code{g}
24300 <- @code{+}
24301 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24302 -> @code{+}
24303 @end smallexample
24304
24305 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24306 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24307 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24308
24309 @menu
24310 * File-I/O Overview::
24311 * Protocol Basics::
24312 * The F Request Packet::
24313 * The F Reply Packet::
24314 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24315 * Console I/O::
24316 * List of Supported Calls::
24317 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24318 * Constants::
24319 * File-I/O Examples::
24320 @end menu
24321
24322 @node File-I/O Overview
24323 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24324 @cindex file-i/o overview
24325
24326 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24327 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24328 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24329 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24330 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24331 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24332
24333 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24334 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24335 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24336 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24337 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24338
24339 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24340 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24341 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24342 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24343 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24344 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24345 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24346
24347 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24348 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24349 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24350 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24351 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24352
24353 @smallexample
24354 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24355 <- target requests 'system call X'
24356 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24357 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24358 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24359 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24360 @end smallexample
24361
24362 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24363 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24364 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24365 system are not supported by this protocol.
24366
24367 @node Protocol Basics
24368 @subsection Protocol Basics
24369 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24370
24371 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24372 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24373 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24374 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24375 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24376 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24377 to call the appropriate host system call:
24378
24379 @itemize @bullet
24380 @item
24381 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24382
24383 @item
24384 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24385 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24386 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24387 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24388
24389 @end itemize
24390
24391 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24392
24393 @itemize @bullet
24394 @item
24395 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24396 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24397 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24398 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24399 packet.
24400
24401 @item
24402 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24403 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24404
24405 @item
24406 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24407
24408 @item
24409 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24410
24411 @item
24412 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24413 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24414 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24415 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24416 packet.
24417
24418 @end itemize
24419
24420 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24421 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24422
24423 @itemize @bullet
24424 @item
24425 Return value.
24426
24427 @item
24428 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24429
24430 @item
24431 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24432
24433 @end itemize
24434
24435 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24436 the latest continue or step action.
24437
24438 @node The F Request Packet
24439 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
24440 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24441 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24442
24443 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24444
24445 @table @samp
24446 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24447
24448 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24449 This is just the name of the function.
24450
24451 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24452 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24453 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24454 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24455 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24456 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24457 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24458
24459 @end table
24460
24461
24462
24463 @node The F Reply Packet
24464 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
24465 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24466 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24467
24468 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24469
24470 @table @samp
24471
24472 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
24473
24474 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24475
24476 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
24477 representation.
24478 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24479
24480 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24481 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24482 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24483
24484 @smallexample
24485 F0,0,C
24486 @end smallexample
24487
24488 @noindent
24489 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24490
24491 @smallexample
24492 F-1,4,C
24493 @end smallexample
24494
24495 @noindent
24496 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24497
24498 @end table
24499
24500
24501 @node The Ctrl-C Message
24502 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
24503 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24504
24505 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24506 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
24507 the target should behave as if it had
24508 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24509 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24510 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24511 packet.
24512
24513 It's important for the target to know in which
24514 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24515
24516 @itemize @bullet
24517 @item
24518 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24519
24520 @item
24521 The system call on the host has been finished.
24522
24523 @end itemize
24524
24525 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24526 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24527 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24528 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24529 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24530 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24531
24532 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24533 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24534 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24535 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24536 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24537 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24538 or the full action has been completed.
24539
24540 @node Console I/O
24541 @subsection Console I/O
24542 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24543
24544 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24545 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24546 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24547 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24548 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24549 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24550 conditions is met:
24551
24552 @itemize @bullet
24553 @item
24554 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24555 @code{read}
24556 system call is treated as finished.
24557
24558 @item
24559 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24560 newline.
24561
24562 @item
24563 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24564 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24565
24566 @end itemize
24567
24568 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24569 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24570 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24571 is stopped at the user's request.
24572
24573
24574 @node List of Supported Calls
24575 @subsection List of Supported Calls
24576 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24577
24578 @menu
24579 * open::
24580 * close::
24581 * read::
24582 * write::
24583 * lseek::
24584 * rename::
24585 * unlink::
24586 * stat/fstat::
24587 * gettimeofday::
24588 * isatty::
24589 * system::
24590 @end menu
24591
24592 @node open
24593 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24594 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24595
24596 @table @asis
24597 @item Synopsis:
24598 @smallexample
24599 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24600 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24601 @end smallexample
24602
24603 @item Request:
24604 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24605
24606 @noindent
24607 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24608
24609 @table @code
24610 @item O_CREAT
24611 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24612 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24613 are concerned.
24614
24615 @item O_EXCL
24616 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24617 an error and open() fails.
24618
24619 @item O_TRUNC
24620 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24621 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24622 truncated to zero length.
24623
24624 @item O_APPEND
24625 The file is opened in append mode.
24626
24627 @item O_RDONLY
24628 The file is opened for reading only.
24629
24630 @item O_WRONLY
24631 The file is opened for writing only.
24632
24633 @item O_RDWR
24634 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24635 @end table
24636
24637 @noindent
24638 Other bits are silently ignored.
24639
24640
24641 @noindent
24642 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24643
24644 @table @code
24645 @item S_IRUSR
24646 User has read permission.
24647
24648 @item S_IWUSR
24649 User has write permission.
24650
24651 @item S_IRGRP
24652 Group has read permission.
24653
24654 @item S_IWGRP
24655 Group has write permission.
24656
24657 @item S_IROTH
24658 Others have read permission.
24659
24660 @item S_IWOTH
24661 Others have write permission.
24662 @end table
24663
24664 @noindent
24665 Other bits are silently ignored.
24666
24667
24668 @item Return value:
24669 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24670 occurred.
24671
24672 @item Errors:
24673
24674 @table @code
24675 @item EEXIST
24676 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24677
24678 @item EISDIR
24679 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24680
24681 @item EACCES
24682 The requested access is not allowed.
24683
24684 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24685 @var{pathname} was too long.
24686
24687 @item ENOENT
24688 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24689
24690 @item ENODEV
24691 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24692
24693 @item EROFS
24694 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24695 write access was requested.
24696
24697 @item EFAULT
24698 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24699
24700 @item ENOSPC
24701 No space on device to create the file.
24702
24703 @item EMFILE
24704 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24705
24706 @item ENFILE
24707 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24708 has been reached.
24709
24710 @item EINTR
24711 The call was interrupted by the user.
24712 @end table
24713
24714 @end table
24715
24716 @node close
24717 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24718 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24719
24720 @table @asis
24721 @item Synopsis:
24722 @smallexample
24723 int close(int fd);
24724 @end smallexample
24725
24726 @item Request:
24727 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24728
24729 @item Return value:
24730 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24731
24732 @item Errors:
24733
24734 @table @code
24735 @item EBADF
24736 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24737
24738 @item EINTR
24739 The call was interrupted by the user.
24740 @end table
24741
24742 @end table
24743
24744 @node read
24745 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24746 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24747
24748 @table @asis
24749 @item Synopsis:
24750 @smallexample
24751 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24752 @end smallexample
24753
24754 @item Request:
24755 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24756
24757 @item Return value:
24758 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24759 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24760 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24761
24762 @item Errors:
24763
24764 @table @code
24765 @item EBADF
24766 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24767 reading.
24768
24769 @item EFAULT
24770 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24771
24772 @item EINTR
24773 The call was interrupted by the user.
24774 @end table
24775
24776 @end table
24777
24778 @node write
24779 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24780 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24781
24782 @table @asis
24783 @item Synopsis:
24784 @smallexample
24785 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24786 @end smallexample
24787
24788 @item Request:
24789 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24790
24791 @item Return value:
24792 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24793 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24794 is returned.
24795
24796 @item Errors:
24797
24798 @table @code
24799 @item EBADF
24800 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24801 writing.
24802
24803 @item EFAULT
24804 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24805
24806 @item EFBIG
24807 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24808 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
24809
24810 @item ENOSPC
24811 No space on device to write the data.
24812
24813 @item EINTR
24814 The call was interrupted by the user.
24815 @end table
24816
24817 @end table
24818
24819 @node lseek
24820 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24821 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24822
24823 @table @asis
24824 @item Synopsis:
24825 @smallexample
24826 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24827 @end smallexample
24828
24829 @item Request:
24830 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24831
24832 @var{flag} is one of:
24833
24834 @table @code
24835 @item SEEK_SET
24836 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24837
24838 @item SEEK_CUR
24839 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24840 bytes.
24841
24842 @item SEEK_END
24843 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24844 bytes.
24845 @end table
24846
24847 @item Return value:
24848 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24849 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24850 value of -1 is returned.
24851
24852 @item Errors:
24853
24854 @table @code
24855 @item EBADF
24856 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24857
24858 @item ESPIPE
24859 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24860
24861 @item EINVAL
24862 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24863
24864 @item EINTR
24865 The call was interrupted by the user.
24866 @end table
24867
24868 @end table
24869
24870 @node rename
24871 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24872 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24873
24874 @table @asis
24875 @item Synopsis:
24876 @smallexample
24877 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24878 @end smallexample
24879
24880 @item Request:
24881 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24882
24883 @item Return value:
24884 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24885
24886 @item Errors:
24887
24888 @table @code
24889 @item EISDIR
24890 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24891 directory.
24892
24893 @item EEXIST
24894 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24895
24896 @item EBUSY
24897 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24898 process.
24899
24900 @item EINVAL
24901 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24902 of itself.
24903
24904 @item ENOTDIR
24905 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24906 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24907 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24908
24909 @item EFAULT
24910 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24911
24912 @item EACCES
24913 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24914
24915 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24916
24917 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24918
24919 @item ENOENT
24920 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24921
24922 @item EROFS
24923 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24924
24925 @item ENOSPC
24926 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24927 directory entry.
24928
24929 @item EINTR
24930 The call was interrupted by the user.
24931 @end table
24932
24933 @end table
24934
24935 @node unlink
24936 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24937 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24938
24939 @table @asis
24940 @item Synopsis:
24941 @smallexample
24942 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24943 @end smallexample
24944
24945 @item Request:
24946 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24947
24948 @item Return value:
24949 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24950
24951 @item Errors:
24952
24953 @table @code
24954 @item EACCES
24955 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24956
24957 @item EPERM
24958 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24959
24960 @item EBUSY
24961 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24962 being used by another process.
24963
24964 @item EFAULT
24965 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24966
24967 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24968 @var{pathname} was too long.
24969
24970 @item ENOENT
24971 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24972
24973 @item ENOTDIR
24974 A component of the path is not a directory.
24975
24976 @item EROFS
24977 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24978
24979 @item EINTR
24980 The call was interrupted by the user.
24981 @end table
24982
24983 @end table
24984
24985 @node stat/fstat
24986 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24987 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24988 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24989
24990 @table @asis
24991 @item Synopsis:
24992 @smallexample
24993 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24994 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24995 @end smallexample
24996
24997 @item Request:
24998 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24999 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25000
25001 @item Return value:
25002 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25003
25004 @item Errors:
25005
25006 @table @code
25007 @item EBADF
25008 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25009
25010 @item ENOENT
25011 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25012 path is an empty string.
25013
25014 @item ENOTDIR
25015 A component of the path is not a directory.
25016
25017 @item EFAULT
25018 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25019
25020 @item EACCES
25021 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25022
25023 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25024 @var{pathname} was too long.
25025
25026 @item EINTR
25027 The call was interrupted by the user.
25028 @end table
25029
25030 @end table
25031
25032 @node gettimeofday
25033 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25034 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25035
25036 @table @asis
25037 @item Synopsis:
25038 @smallexample
25039 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25040 @end smallexample
25041
25042 @item Request:
25043 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25044
25045 @item Return value:
25046 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25047
25048 @item Errors:
25049
25050 @table @code
25051 @item EINVAL
25052 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25053
25054 @item EFAULT
25055 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25056 @end table
25057
25058 @end table
25059
25060 @node isatty
25061 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25062 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25063
25064 @table @asis
25065 @item Synopsis:
25066 @smallexample
25067 int isatty(int fd);
25068 @end smallexample
25069
25070 @item Request:
25071 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25072
25073 @item Return value:
25074 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25075
25076 @item Errors:
25077
25078 @table @code
25079 @item EINTR
25080 The call was interrupted by the user.
25081 @end table
25082
25083 @end table
25084
25085 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25086 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25087 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25088 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25089 needed.
25090
25091
25092 @node system
25093 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25094 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25095
25096 @table @asis
25097 @item Synopsis:
25098 @smallexample
25099 int system(const char *command);
25100 @end smallexample
25101
25102 @item Request:
25103 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25104
25105 @item Return value:
25106 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25107 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25108 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25109 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25110 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25111 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25112 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25113
25114 @item Errors:
25115
25116 @table @code
25117 @item EINTR
25118 The call was interrupted by the user.
25119 @end table
25120
25121 @end table
25122
25123 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25124 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25125 the host is simplified before it's returned
25126 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25127 is discarded, and the return value consists
25128 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25129
25130 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25131 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25132 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25133
25134 @table @code
25135 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25136 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25137 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25138 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25139
25140 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25141 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25142 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25143 protocol.
25144 @end table
25145
25146 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25147 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25148 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25149
25150 @menu
25151 * Integral Datatypes::
25152 * Pointer Values::
25153 * Memory Transfer::
25154 * struct stat::
25155 * struct timeval::
25156 @end menu
25157
25158 @node Integral Datatypes
25159 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25160 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25161
25162 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25163 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25164 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25165
25166 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25167 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25168
25169 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25170
25171 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25172 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25173
25174 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25175
25176 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25177 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25178 byte order.
25179
25180 @node Pointer Values
25181 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25182 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25183
25184 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25185 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25186 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25187 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25188
25189 @smallexample
25190 @code{1aaf/12}
25191 @end smallexample
25192
25193 @noindent
25194 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25195 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25196 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25197 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25198
25199 @smallexample
25200 @code{123456/d}
25201 @end smallexample
25202
25203 @node Memory Transfer
25204 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25205 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25206
25207 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25208 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25209 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25210 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25211 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25212 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25213 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25214
25215
25216 @node struct stat
25217 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25218 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25219
25220 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25221 is defined as follows:
25222
25223 @smallexample
25224 struct stat @{
25225 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25226 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25227 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25228 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25229 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25230 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25231 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25232 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25233 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25234 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25235 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25236 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25237 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25238 @};
25239 @end smallexample
25240
25241 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25242 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25243 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25244
25245 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25246 range of values.
25247
25248 @table @code
25249
25250 @item st_dev
25251 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25252
25253 @item st_ino
25254 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25255
25256 @item st_mode
25257 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25258 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25259
25260 @item st_uid
25261 @itemx st_gid
25262 @itemx st_rdev
25263 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25264
25265 @item st_atime
25266 @itemx st_mtime
25267 @itemx st_ctime
25268 These values have a host and file system dependent
25269 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25270 support exact timing values.
25271 @end table
25272
25273 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25274 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25275 continuing.
25276
25277 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25278 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25279 get truncated on the target.
25280
25281 @node struct timeval
25282 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25283 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25284
25285 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25286 is defined as follows:
25287
25288 @smallexample
25289 struct timeval @{
25290 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25291 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25292 @};
25293 @end smallexample
25294
25295 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25296 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25297 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25298
25299 @node Constants
25300 @subsection Constants
25301 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25302
25303 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25304 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25305 values before and after the call as needed.
25306
25307 @menu
25308 * Open Flags::
25309 * mode_t Values::
25310 * Errno Values::
25311 * Lseek Flags::
25312 * Limits::
25313 @end menu
25314
25315 @node Open Flags
25316 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25317 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25318
25319 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25320
25321 @smallexample
25322 O_RDONLY 0x0
25323 O_WRONLY 0x1
25324 O_RDWR 0x2
25325 O_APPEND 0x8
25326 O_CREAT 0x200
25327 O_TRUNC 0x400
25328 O_EXCL 0x800
25329 @end smallexample
25330
25331 @node mode_t Values
25332 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25333 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25334
25335 All values are given in octal representation.
25336
25337 @smallexample
25338 S_IFREG 0100000
25339 S_IFDIR 040000
25340 S_IRUSR 0400
25341 S_IWUSR 0200
25342 S_IXUSR 0100
25343 S_IRGRP 040
25344 S_IWGRP 020
25345 S_IXGRP 010
25346 S_IROTH 04
25347 S_IWOTH 02
25348 S_IXOTH 01
25349 @end smallexample
25350
25351 @node Errno Values
25352 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25353 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25354
25355 All values are given in decimal representation.
25356
25357 @smallexample
25358 EPERM 1
25359 ENOENT 2
25360 EINTR 4
25361 EBADF 9
25362 EACCES 13
25363 EFAULT 14
25364 EBUSY 16
25365 EEXIST 17
25366 ENODEV 19
25367 ENOTDIR 20
25368 EISDIR 21
25369 EINVAL 22
25370 ENFILE 23
25371 EMFILE 24
25372 EFBIG 27
25373 ENOSPC 28
25374 ESPIPE 29
25375 EROFS 30
25376 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25377 EUNKNOWN 9999
25378 @end smallexample
25379
25380 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25381 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25382
25383 @node Lseek Flags
25384 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25385 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25386
25387 @smallexample
25388 SEEK_SET 0
25389 SEEK_CUR 1
25390 SEEK_END 2
25391 @end smallexample
25392
25393 @node Limits
25394 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25395 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25396
25397 All values are given in decimal representation.
25398
25399 @smallexample
25400 INT_MIN -2147483648
25401 INT_MAX 2147483647
25402 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25403 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25404 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25405 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25406 @end smallexample
25407
25408 @node File-I/O Examples
25409 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25410 @cindex file-i/o examples
25411
25412 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25413 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25414
25415 @smallexample
25416 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25417 @emph{request memory read from target}
25418 -> @code{m1234,6}
25419 <- XXXXXX
25420 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25421 -> @code{F6}
25422 @end smallexample
25423
25424 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25425 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25426
25427 @smallexample
25428 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25429 @emph{request memory write to target}
25430 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25431 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25432 -> @code{F6}
25433 @end smallexample
25434
25435 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25436 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25437
25438 @smallexample
25439 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25440 -> @code{F-1,9}
25441 @end smallexample
25442
25443 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25444 host is called:
25445
25446 @smallexample
25447 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25448 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25449 <- @code{T02}
25450 @end smallexample
25451
25452 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25453 host is called:
25454
25455 @smallexample
25456 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25457 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25458 <- @code{T02}
25459 @end smallexample
25460
25461 @node Library List Format
25462 @section Library List Format
25463 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
25464
25465 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
25466 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
25467 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
25468 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
25469 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
25470 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
25471 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25472 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
25473 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
25474 are loaded.
25475
25476 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
25477 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
25478 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
25479 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
25480 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
25481 link-time base addresses.
25482
25483 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
25484 offset, looks like this:
25485
25486 @smallexample
25487 <library-list>
25488 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
25489 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
25490 </library>
25491 </library-list>
25492 @end smallexample
25493
25494 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
25495
25496 @smallexample
25497 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
25498 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
25499 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
25500 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
25501 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25502 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
25503 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
25504 @end smallexample
25505
25506 @node Memory Map Format
25507 @section Memory Map Format
25508 @cindex memory map format
25509
25510 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25511 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25512 memory map.
25513
25514 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25515 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25516 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25517
25518 @smallexample
25519 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25520 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25521 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25522 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25523 <memory-map>
25524 region...
25525 </memory-map>
25526 @end smallexample
25527
25528 Each region can be either:
25529
25530 @itemize
25531
25532 @item
25533 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25534 bytes from there:
25535
25536 @smallexample
25537 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25538 @end smallexample
25539
25540
25541 @item
25542 A region of read-only memory:
25543
25544 @smallexample
25545 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25546 @end smallexample
25547
25548
25549 @item
25550 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25551 bytes in length:
25552
25553 @smallexample
25554 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25555 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25556 </memory>
25557 @end smallexample
25558
25559 @end itemize
25560
25561 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25562 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25563 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25564
25565 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25566
25567 @smallexample
25568 <!-- ................................................... -->
25569 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25570 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25571 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25572 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25573 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25574 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25575 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25576 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25577 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25578 and its type, or device. -->
25579 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25580 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25581 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25582 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25583 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25584 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25585 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25586 @end smallexample
25587
25588 @include agentexpr.texi
25589
25590 @node Target Descriptions
25591 @appendix Target Descriptions
25592 @cindex target descriptions
25593
25594 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25595 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25596 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25597
25598 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25599 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25600 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25601 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25602 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25603 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25604 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25605
25606 @itemize @bullet
25607 @item
25608 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25609 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25610 @item
25611 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25612 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25613 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25614 @item
25615 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25616 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25617 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25618 @end itemize
25619
25620 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25621 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25622 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25623 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25624 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25625
25626 @value{GDBN} must be compiled with Expat support to support XML target
25627 descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25628
25629 @menu
25630 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25631 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25632 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25633 descriptions.
25634 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25635 @end menu
25636
25637 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25638 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25639
25640 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25641 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25642 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25643 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25644 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25645 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25646 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25647 Format}.
25648
25649 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25650 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25651 specify a file are:
25652
25653 @table @code
25654 @cindex set tdesc filename
25655 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25656 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25657
25658 @cindex unset tdesc filename
25659 @item unset tdesc filename
25660 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25661 will use the description supplied by the current target.
25662
25663 @cindex show tdesc filename
25664 @item show tdesc filename
25665 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25666 @end table
25667
25668
25669 @node Target Description Format
25670 @section Target Description Format
25671 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
25672
25673 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25674 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25675 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25676 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25677 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25678 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25679 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25680
25681 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
25682 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
25683 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
25684 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
25685
25686 Here is a simple target description:
25687
25688 @smallexample
25689 <target version="1.0">
25690 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25691 </target>
25692 @end smallexample
25693
25694 @noindent
25695 This minimal description only says that the target uses
25696 the x86-64 architecture.
25697
25698 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
25699 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
25700 are explained further below.
25701
25702 @smallexample
25703 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25704 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25705 <target version="1.0">
25706 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
25707 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
25708 </target>
25709 @end smallexample
25710
25711 @noindent
25712 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25713 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25714 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25715 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25716 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
25717 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
25718 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
25719 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
25720 the version mismatch.
25721
25722 @subsection Inclusion
25723 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
25724 @cindex XInclude
25725 @ifnotinfo
25726 @cindex <xi:include>
25727 @end ifnotinfo
25728
25729 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
25730 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
25731 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
25732 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
25733 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
25734
25735 @smallexample
25736 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
25737 @end smallexample
25738
25739 @noindent
25740 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
25741 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
25742 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
25743 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
25744 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
25745 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
25746 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
25747 original description.
25748
25749 @subsection Architecture
25750 @cindex <architecture>
25751
25752 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
25753
25754 @smallexample
25755 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
25756 @end smallexample
25757
25758 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
25759 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
25760 Debugging Target}).
25761
25762 @subsection Features
25763 @cindex <feature>
25764
25765 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
25766 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
25767 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
25768 has this form:
25769
25770 @smallexample
25771 <feature name="@var{name}">
25772 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
25773 @var{reg}@dots{}
25774 </feature>
25775 @end smallexample
25776
25777 @noindent
25778 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
25779 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
25780 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
25781 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
25782
25783 @subsection Types
25784
25785 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
25786 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
25787 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
25788 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
25789 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
25790
25791 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
25792 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
25793 Types must be defined before they are used.
25794
25795 @cindex <vector>
25796 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
25797 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
25798 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
25799 @var{count}:
25800
25801 @smallexample
25802 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
25803 @end smallexample
25804
25805 @cindex <union>
25806 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
25807 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
25808 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
25809 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
25810
25811 @smallexample
25812 <union id="@var{id}">
25813 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
25814 @dots{}
25815 </union>
25816 @end smallexample
25817
25818 @subsection Registers
25819 @cindex <reg>
25820
25821 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
25822
25823 @smallexample
25824 <reg name="@var{name}"
25825 bitsize="@var{size}"
25826 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
25827 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
25828 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
25829 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
25830 @end smallexample
25831
25832 @noindent
25833 The components are as follows:
25834
25835 @table @var
25836
25837 @item name
25838 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
25839
25840 @item bitsize
25841 The register's size, in bits.
25842
25843 @item regnum
25844 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
25845 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
25846 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
25847 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
25848 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
25849 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
25850 in order of increasing register number.
25851
25852 @item save-restore
25853 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
25854 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
25855 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
25856 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
25857 ABI.
25858
25859 @item type
25860 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
25861 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
25862 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
25863 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
25864 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
25865 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
25866
25867 @item group
25868 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
25869 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
25870 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
25871 in @code{info registers}.
25872
25873 @end table
25874
25875 @node Predefined Target Types
25876 @section Predefined Target Types
25877 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
25878
25879 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
25880 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
25881 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
25882 types. The currently supported types are:
25883
25884 @table @code
25885
25886 @item int8
25887 @itemx int16
25888 @itemx int32
25889 @itemx int64
25890 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25891
25892 @item uint8
25893 @itemx uint16
25894 @itemx uint32
25895 @itemx uint64
25896 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25897
25898 @item code_ptr
25899 @itemx data_ptr
25900 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
25901 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
25902 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
25903 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
25904 may be marked as data pointers.
25905
25906 @item ieee_single
25907 Single precision IEEE floating point.
25908
25909 @item ieee_double
25910 Double precision IEEE floating point.
25911
25912 @item arm_fpa_ext
25913 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
25914
25915 @end table
25916
25917 @node Standard Target Features
25918 @section Standard Target Features
25919 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
25920
25921 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
25922 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
25923 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
25924 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
25925 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
25926 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
25927 can recognize them.
25928
25929 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
25930 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
25931 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
25932 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
25933 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
25934 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
25935 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
25936 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
25937
25938 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
25939 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
25940 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
25941
25942 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
25943 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
25944 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
25945 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
25946
25947 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
25948 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
25949 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
25950
25951 @menu
25952 * ARM Features::
25953 * M68K Features::
25954 @end menu
25955
25956
25957 @node ARM Features
25958 @subsection ARM Features
25959 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
25960
25961 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
25962 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
25963 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
25964
25965 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
25966 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
25967
25968 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
25969 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
25970 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
25971 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
25972
25973 @subsection MIPS Features
25974 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
25975
25976 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
25977 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
25978 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
25979 on the target.
25980
25981 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
25982 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
25983 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
25984
25985 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
25986 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
25987 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
25988 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
25989
25990 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
25991 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
25992 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
25993
25994 @node M68K Features
25995 @subsection M68K Features
25996 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
25997
25998 @table @code
25999 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26000 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26001 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26002 One of those features must be always present.
26003 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26004 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26005 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26006 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26007
26008 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26009 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26010 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26011 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26012 @end table
26013
26014 @include gpl.texi
26015
26016 @raisesections
26017 @include fdl.texi
26018 @lowersections
26019
26020 @node Index
26021 @unnumbered Index
26022
26023 @printindex cp
26024
26025 @tex
26026 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26027 % meantime:
26028 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26029 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26030 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26031 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26032 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26033 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26034 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26035 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26036 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26037 \page\colophon
26038 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26039 @end tex
26040
26041 @bye
This page took 0.769842 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.